blob: 4f7da73fd76b468e973bbea4f91031c7e74da327 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau910d5ac2019-12-21 12:45:18 +01007 2019/12/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
852 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001414max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1415 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1416 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1417 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1418 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1419 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1420 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1421 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1422 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424maxconn <number>
1425 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1426 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1427 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001428 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1429 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1430 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1431 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001432 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1433 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1434 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1435 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1436 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1437 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001439maxconnrate <number>
1440 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1441 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1442 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1443 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1444 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1445 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1446 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1447 fairness.
1448
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001449maxcomprate <number>
1450 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001451 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001452 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1453 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1454 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 default value.
1457
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001458maxcompcpuusage <number>
1459 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1460 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1461 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1462 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1463 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1464 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1465 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1466 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1467
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001468maxpipes <number>
1469 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1470 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1471 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1472 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1473 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1474 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1475
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001476maxsessrate <number>
1477 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1478 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1479 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1480 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1481 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1482 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1483 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1484 fairness.
1485
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001486maxsslconn <number>
1487 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1488 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1489 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1490 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1491 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1492 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1493 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001494 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1495 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1496 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1497 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1498 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1499 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1500 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001501
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001502maxsslrate <number>
1503 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1504 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1505 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1506 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1507 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1508 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1509 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1510 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1511 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1512 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1513
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001514maxzlibmem <number>
1515 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1516 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1517 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001518 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1519 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1520 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001522noepoll
1523 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1524 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001525 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526
1527nokqueue
1528 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1529 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1530 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1531
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001532noevports
1533 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1534 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1535 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1536 also "nopoll".
1537
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001538nopoll
1539 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1540 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001542 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1543 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001544
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001545nosplice
1546 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001547 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001548 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001550 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1551 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1552 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1553 "option splice-response".
1554
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001555nogetaddrinfo
1556 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1557 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1558
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001559noreuseport
1560 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1561 command line argument "-dR".
1562
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001563profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1564 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1565 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1566 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1567 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001568 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001569 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1570 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1571 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1572 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1573
1574 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1575 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1576 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1577 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1578 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001579 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1580 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1581 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1582 CLI.
1583
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001584spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001585 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1586 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1587 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1588 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1589 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1590 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001591
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001593 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001594 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001595 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1596 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1597 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1598 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1599 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001600 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1601 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001602 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1603 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1604 openssl configuration file uses:
1605 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1606
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001607ssl-mode-async
1608 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001609 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001610 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1611 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1612 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001613 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001615
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001616tune.buffers.limit <number>
1617 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1618 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1619 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1620 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1621 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001622 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001623 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1624 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1625 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1626 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1627 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1628 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1629 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1630 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1631 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1632
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001633tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1634 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1635 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1636 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1637 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1638
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001639tune.bufsize <number>
1640 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1641 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1642 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1643 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1644 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1645 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1646 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001647 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1648 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1649 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001650 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001651 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1652 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1653 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001654
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001655tune.chksize <number>
1656 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1657 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1658 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1659 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1660 checks whenever possible.
1661
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001662tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1663 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1664 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1665 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1666 this value. The default value is 1.
1667
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001668tune.fail-alloc
1669 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1670 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1671 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1672 gracefully.
1673
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001674tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1675 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1676 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1677 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1678 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1679 change it.
1680
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001681tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1682 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001683 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1684 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1686 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1687 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1688 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1689 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1690
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001691tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1692 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1693 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1694 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1695 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1696 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1697 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1698 recommended not to change this value.
1699
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001700tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1701 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1702 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1703 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1704 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1705 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1706 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1707 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1708
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001709tune.http.cookielen <number>
1710 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1711 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1712 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1713 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1714 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1715 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1716 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1717 to change this value.
1718
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001719tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001720 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1721 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001722 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001723 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001724 configuration directives too.
1725 The default value is 1024.
1726
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001727tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1728 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1729 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1730 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1731 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1732 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1733 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001734 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1735 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1736 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001737
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001738tune.idletimer <timeout>
1739 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1740 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1741 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1742 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1743 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1744 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001745 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001747 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1748
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001749tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1750 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1751 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1752 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1753 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1754 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1755 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1756 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1757 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1758 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1759
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001760tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1761 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001762 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001763 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1764 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001765 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001766 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1767 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1768
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001769tune.lua.maxmem
1770 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1771 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1772 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1773 memory.
1774
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001775tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1776 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001777 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1778 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001780
1781tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1782 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1783 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1784 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1785 check servers.
1786
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001787tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1788 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1789 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1790 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001791 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001792
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001793tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001794 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1795 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1796 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1797 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1798 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1799 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1800 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1801 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1802 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1803 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001804
1805tune.maxpollevents <number>
1806 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1807 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1808 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1809 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1810 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1811
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001812tune.maxrewrite <number>
1813 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1814 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1815 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1816 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1817 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1818 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1819 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1820 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1821 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1822 bufsize.
1823
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001824tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1825 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1826 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1827 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1828 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1829 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1830 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1831 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1832 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1833 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001834 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1835 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001836 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1837 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1838 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1839 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1840 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1841 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1842 setting this parameter to 0.
1843
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001844tune.pipesize <number>
1845 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1846 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1847 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1848 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1849 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1850 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1851
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001852tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1853 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1854 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1855 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1856 default is 20.
1857
1858tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1859 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1860 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1861 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1862 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1863 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1864 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001865 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001866
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001867tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1868tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1869 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1870 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1871 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001872 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001873 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001874 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1875 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1876
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001877tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001878 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001879 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1880 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1881 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1882 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1883
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001884tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001885 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001886 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1887 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1888
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001889tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1890tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1891 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1892 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1893 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001894 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001895 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001896 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1897 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1898 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1899 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1900 notifying haproxy again.
1901
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001902tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001903 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1904 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1905 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001906 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001909 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1910 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1911 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001912 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1913 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001914
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001915tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001916 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001917 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1918 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1919 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1920 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1921 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1922
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001923tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1924 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001925 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001926 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1927 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1928 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1929 being used for too long.
1930
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001931tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1932 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1933 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1934 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1935 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1936 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1937 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1938 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1939 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1940 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1941 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001943 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001944
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001945tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1946 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1947 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1948 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1949 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1950 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1951 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1952 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001953 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1954 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001955
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001956tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1957 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1958 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1959 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1960 1000 entries.
1961
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001962tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1963 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1964 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1965 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1966
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001967tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001968tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001969tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1970tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1971tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1973 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1974 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1975 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1976 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1977 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1978 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1979 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001980
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001981 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1982 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1983 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1984 all available space is consumed.
1985 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1986 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1987 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001988
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001989tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1990 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001991 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001992 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001993 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001994 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1995
1996tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1997 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1998 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001999 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2000 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020023.3. Debugging
2003--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
2005debug
2006 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2007 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2008 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2009 system startup.
2010
2011quiet
2012 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2013 line argument "-q".
2014
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020163.4. Userlists
2017--------------
2018It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2019http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2020it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2021
2022userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002023 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002024 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2025
2026group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2029 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2030
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002031user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2032 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002033 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2034 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002035 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2036 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2037 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2038 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002039
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002040 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2041 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2042 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2043 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2044 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2045 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2046 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2047 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2048 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002049
2050 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002051 userlist L1
2052 group G1 users tiger,scott
2053 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002054
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2056 user scott insecure-password elgato
2057 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 userlist L2
2060 group G1
2061 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2064 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2065 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
2067 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002068
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002069
20703.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002071----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002072It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2073several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2074instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2075values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2076automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2077In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2078using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2079tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2080reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2081Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2082that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2083each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002084
2085peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002086 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002087 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2088
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002089bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2090 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2091 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2092
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002093disabled
2094 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2095 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2096 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2097
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002098default-bind [param*]
2099 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2100
2101default-server [param*]
2102 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2103
2104 Arguments:
2105 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2106 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2107 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2108 details.
2109
2110
2111 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2112
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002113enable
2114 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2115
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002116peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002117 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2118 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2119 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2120 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2121 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2122 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2123
2124 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2125 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2126
2127 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2128 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2129 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2130 across all peers.
2131
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002132 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2133 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002134
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002135 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2136 "server" keyword explanation below).
2137
2138server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002139 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002140 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2141 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2142 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2143 of this "peers" section).
2144 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2145
2146
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002147 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002148 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002149 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002150 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2151 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2152 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153
2154 backend mybackend
2155 mode tcp
2156 balance roundrobin
2157 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2158 stick on src
2159
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002160 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2161 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163 Example:
2164 peers mypeers
2165 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2166 default-server ssl verify none
2167 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2168 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002169
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002170
2171table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2172 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2173
2174 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2175 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002176 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002177 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2178 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2179 "stick-table" keyword).
2180
2181 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2182 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2183 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2184 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2185 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2186 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2187 of the stick-table name as follows:
2188
2189 peers mypeers
2190 peer A ...
2191 peer B ...
2192 table t1 ...
2193
2194 frontend fe1
2195 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2196
2197 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2198 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2199
2200 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2201 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2202 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2203 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2204 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2205 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2206 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2207
2208 peers mypeers
2209 peer A ...
2210 peer B ...
2211 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2212
2213 backend t1
2214 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2215
2216 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2217 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2218 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2219
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022203.6. Mailers
2221------------
2222It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2223If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2224in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2225
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002226mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002227 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2228 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2229
2230mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2231 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2232
2233 Example:
2234 mailers mymailers
2235 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2236 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2237
2238 backend mybackend
2239 mode tcp
2240 balance roundrobin
2241
2242 email-alert mailers mymailers
2243 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2244 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2245
2246 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2247 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2248
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002249timeout mail <time>
2250 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2251 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2252 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2253 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2254
2255 Example:
2256 mailers mymailers
2257 timeout mail 20s
2258 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002259
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022603.7. Programs
2261-------------
2262In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2263master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2264managed the same way as the workers.
2265
2266During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2267sequence as a worker:
2268
2269 - the master is re-executed
2270 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2271 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2272 instance of the program
2273
2274During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2275
2276program <name>
2277 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2278 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2279 the management guide).
2280
2281command <command> [arguments*]
2282 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2283 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2284 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2285 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2286
2287option start-on-reload
2288no option start-on-reload
2289 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2290 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2291 program section.
2292
2293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002295----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002297Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002298 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299 - frontend <name>
2300 - backend <name>
2301 - listen <name>
2302
2303A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2304its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2305section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002307
2308A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2309connections.
2310
2311A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2312to forward incoming connections.
2313
2314A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2315parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2318'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2319case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2320
2321Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2322logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2323proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2324However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2325name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2326
2327Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2328and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002329bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2331modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2332arbitrary criteria.
2333
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002334In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2335a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002336the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002337
2338 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2339 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2340 between responses and new requests.
2341
2342 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2343 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2344 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002345 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2346 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2347 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2348 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002349
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002350 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2351 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2352 client-facing connection remains open.
2353
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002354 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2355 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002356
2357The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2358frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2359following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002360weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002361
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002362 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002363
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2365 ----+-----+-----+----
2366 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2367 ----+-----+-----+----
2368 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2369 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2370 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023764.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2377--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002379The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2380limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2381they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2382limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002383marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002385and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2386with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2387specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002390 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2391------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2392acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002393backlog X X X -
2394balance X - X X
2395bind - X X -
2396bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002397block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002398capture cookie - X X -
2399capture request header - X X -
2400capture response header - X X -
2401clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002402compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002403contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2404cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002405declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406default-server X - X X
2407default_backend X X X -
2408description - X X X
2409disabled X X X X
2410dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002411email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002412email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002413email-alert mailers X X X X
2414email-alert myhostname X X X X
2415email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002416enabled X X X X
2417errorfile X X X X
2418errorloc X X X X
2419errorloc302 X X X X
2420-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2421errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002422force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002423filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002424fullconn X - X X
2425grace X X X X
2426hash-type X - X X
2427http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002428http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002429http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002430http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002431http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002432http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002433http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002435ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002436load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002437log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002438log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002439log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002440log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002441max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442maxconn X X X -
2443mode X X X X
2444monitor fail - X X -
2445monitor-net X X X -
2446monitor-uri X X X -
2447option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2448option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2449option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2450option allbackups (*) X - X X
2451option checkcache (*) X - X X
2452option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2453option contstats (*) X X X -
2454option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2455option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002456-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2457option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002458option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2459option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002460option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002461option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002462option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002463option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002464option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002465option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002466option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002467option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002468option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option httpchk X - X X
2470option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002471option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002473option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002474option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002475option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2477option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2478option logasap (*) X X X -
2479option mysql-check X - X X
2480option nolinger (*) X X X X
2481option originalto X X X X
2482option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002483option pgsql-check X - X X
2484option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002485option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002486option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002487option smtpchk X - X X
2488option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2489option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2490option splice-request (*) X X X X
2491option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002492option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002493option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2494option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2495-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002496option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2498option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2499option tcpka X X X X
2500option tcplog X X X X
2501option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002502external-check command X - X X
2503external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2505rate-limit sessions X X X -
2506redirect - X X X
2507redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2508redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002509reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2510reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2511reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2512reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2513reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002521-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002522reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002523retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002524retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002525rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2526rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2527rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2528rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2529rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2531rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002532server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002533server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002534server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002535source X - X X
2536srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002537stats admin - X X X
2538stats auth X X X X
2539stats enable X X X X
2540stats hide-version X X X X
2541stats http-request - X X X
2542stats realm X X X X
2543stats refresh X X X X
2544stats scope X X X X
2545stats show-desc X X X X
2546stats show-legends X X X X
2547stats show-node X X X X
2548stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2550stick match - - X X
2551stick on - - X X
2552stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002553stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002554stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002555tcp-check connect - - X X
2556tcp-check expect - - X X
2557tcp-check send - - X X
2558tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002559tcp-request connection - X X -
2560tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002561tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002562tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002563tcp-response content - - X X
2564tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565timeout check X - X X
2566timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002567timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002568timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2569timeout connect X - X X
2570timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2571timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2572timeout http-request X X X X
2573timeout queue X - X X
2574timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002575timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002576timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2577timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002578timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002579transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002580unique-id-format X X X -
2581unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002582use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002583use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002584------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2585 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002586
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025884.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2589---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
2591This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2592
2593
2594acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2595 Declare or complete an access list.
2596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2597 no | yes | yes | yes
2598 Example:
2599 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2600 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2601 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002603 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
2605
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002606backlog <conns>
2607 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2609 yes | yes | yes | no
2610 Arguments :
2611 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2612 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002613 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002614
2615 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2616 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2617 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2618 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2619 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2620 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2621 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2622 backlog parameter.
2623
2624 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2625 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2626 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2627
2628 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2629
2630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002632balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2635 yes | no | yes | yes
2636 Arguments :
2637 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2638 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2639 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2640 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2641
2642 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2643 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2644 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2645 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002646 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002647 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002648 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2649 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2650 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2651 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2652 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2653 it, so that you don't worry.
2654
2655 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2656 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2657 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2658 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2659 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2660 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2661 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2662 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002664 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2665 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2666 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2667 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2668 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2669 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2670 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2671 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2672
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002673 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002674 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002675 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2676 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002677 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002678 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2679 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2680 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2681 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2682 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002683 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2684 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2685 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2686 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2687 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2688 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2691 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2692 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2693 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2694 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2695 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2696 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2697 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2701 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2702 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002704 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2705 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2706 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2707 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2708 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2709 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2710 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2711 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2712 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002717 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002718 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2719 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2720 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2721 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2722 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2723 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2724 URIs start with a leading "/".
2725
2726 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2727 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2728 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2729 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002732 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2733
2734 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002735 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2736 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002737 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2738 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2739 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2740 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002742 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2743 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002744
2745 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2746 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2747 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2748 server will receive the request.
2749
2750 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2751 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2752 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2753 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2754 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002755 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2756 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2757 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002759 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2760 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2761 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2762 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2763 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002765 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002766 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2767 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2768 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2769
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002770 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2771 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2772 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2773
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002774 random
2775 random(<draws>)
2776 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002777 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2778 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2779 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2780 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002781 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2782 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2783 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2784 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2785 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2786 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2787 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2788 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2789 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2790 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2791 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2792 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2793 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2794 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2795 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2796 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2797 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2798 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2799 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2800 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002801
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002802 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002803 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002804 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2805 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2806 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2807 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2808 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2809 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002810 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002811 used instead.
2812
2813 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2814 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2815 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2816 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2817
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002818 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2819 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2820 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2821
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002822 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002825 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2826 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002827
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002828 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2829 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2830 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002832 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002833 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002834 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2835 NTLM relies on.
2836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 Examples :
2838 balance roundrobin
2839 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002840 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002841 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2842 balance hdr(host)
2843 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844
2845 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2846 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002848 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002849 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2850 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2851 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2852 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2853
2854 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2855 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2856 defaults to 16 kB.
2857
2858 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2859 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2860
2861 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2862 Round Robin.
2863
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002864 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002865 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2866 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2867 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2868
2869 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2870
2871 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002872 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002873 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2874 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2875 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002876
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002877 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
2879
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002880bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2881bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2884 no | yes | yes | no
2885 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002886 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2887 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2888 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2889 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002890 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002891 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2892 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2893 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2894 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2895 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2896 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2897 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002898 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2899 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2900 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2901 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2902 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2903 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2904 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002905 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2906 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2907 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002908 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2909 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2910 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2911 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002912 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2913 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2914 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002915
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002916 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2917 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002918 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2919 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2920 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002921 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2922 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2923 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2924 the range.
2925
2926 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2927 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2928 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2929 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2930 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2931 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2932 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002933 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002934 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002936 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002937 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002938 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2939 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2940 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2941 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2942 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2943 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2944
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002945 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2946 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2947 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2948 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2951 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2952 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2953 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2954 in a frontend.
2955
2956 Example :
2957 listen http_proxy
2958 bind :80,:443
2959 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002960 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002962 listen http_https_proxy
2963 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002964 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002965
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002966 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2967 bind ipv6@:80
2968 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2969 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2970
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002971 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002972 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002973
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002974 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2975 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2976 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2977 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2978 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2979
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002980 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002981 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982
2983
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002984bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002985 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2987 yes | yes | yes | yes
2988 Arguments :
2989 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2990 may be used to override a default value.
2991
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002992 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002993 option may be combined with other numbers.
2994
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002995 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002996 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2997 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2998 missing from all processes.
2999
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003000 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003001 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003002 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3003 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3004 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3005 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3006 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003007 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003008
3009 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3010 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3011 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3012 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3013 and 'even' instances.
3014
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003015 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3016 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3017 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3018 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003019
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003020 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3021 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3022
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003023 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3024 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3025 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3026
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003027 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3028 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3029
3030 Example :
3031 listen app_ip1
3032 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003033 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003034
3035 listen app_ip2
3036 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen management
3040 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3045 bind-process 1-4
3046
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003047 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003048
3049
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003050block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 no | yes | yes | yes
3054
3055 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3056 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003057 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003058 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003060 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3061 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3062 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003064 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3065 "http-request deny" instead.
3066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067 Example:
3068 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3069 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3070 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003071 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3072 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3073 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003074
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003075 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3076 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3077 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
3079capture cookie <name> len <length>
3080 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3082 no | yes | yes | no
3083 Arguments :
3084 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3085 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3086 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3087 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003088 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089
3090 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3091 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3092 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3093 right if it exceeds <length>.
3094
3095 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3096 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3097 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3098 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3099
3100 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3101 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3102 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3103
3104 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3105 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3106 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003107 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3108 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3109 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110
3111 Example:
3112 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3113
3114 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003115 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
3117
3118capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003119 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 no | yes | yes | no
3122 Arguments :
3123 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003124 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3126 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3127 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3128
3129 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3130 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3131 it exceeds <length>.
3132
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003133 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3135 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003136 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3137 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3138 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3139 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003140 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003141 environments to find where the request came from.
3142
3143 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3144 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3145 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3146 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003147
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003148 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3149 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3150 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3151 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3152 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153
3154 Example:
3155 capture request header Host len 15
3156 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003157 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003159 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003160 about logging.
3161
3162
3163capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003164 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3166 no | yes | yes | no
3167 Arguments :
3168 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003169 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3171 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3172 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3173
3174 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3175 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3176 it exceeds <length>.
3177
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3180 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3181 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003182 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3183 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3184 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3185 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003187 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3188 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3189 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3190 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3191 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003192
3193 Example:
3194 capture response header Content-length len 9
3195 capture response header Location len 15
3196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003197 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003198 about logging.
3199
3200
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003201clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3204 yes | yes | yes | no
3205 Arguments :
3206 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3208 as explained at the top of this document.
3209
3210 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3211 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3212 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3213 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3214 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3215 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3216 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3217 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003218 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003220 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003221
3222 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3223 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3224 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3225 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3226 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3227 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3228
3229 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3230 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3231
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003232 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3233 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003235compression algo <algorithm> ...
3236compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003237compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003238 Enable HTTP compression.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | yes | yes | yes
3241 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003242 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3243 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3244 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3245
3246 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003247 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3248 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3249 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003250
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003252 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003253
3254 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3255 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3256 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3257 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3258 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003259 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003260
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003261 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3262 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3263 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3264 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3265 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3266 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3267 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003268 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003269
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003270 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003271 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003272 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3273 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3274 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3275 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3276 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003277
3278 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3279 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3280 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3281 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3282 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003283 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3284 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3285 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3286 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3287 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003288 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3289 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003290
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003291 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003292 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3293 "Accept-Encoding" header
3294 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003295 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3297 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3298 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3299 "multipart"
3300 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3301 header
3302 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3303 and later
3304 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3305 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003306 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003307
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003308 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003309
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003310 Examples :
3311 compression algo gzip
3312 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003314
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003315contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3318 yes | no | yes | yes
3319 Arguments :
3320 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3322 as explained at the top of this document.
3323
3324 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003325 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003326 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003327 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3329 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3330 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3331
3332 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3333 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3334 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3335 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3336 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3337 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3338
3339 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3340 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3341 instead.
3342
3343 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3344 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3345
3346
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003347cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003348 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3349 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003350 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3353 yes | no | yes | yes
3354 Arguments :
3355 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3356 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3357 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3358 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3359 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3360 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003361 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3363 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3364
3365 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3366 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3367 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3368 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3369 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3370 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003371 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3372 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003373 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003374 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3375 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003376
3377 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003378 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003379
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003380 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003381 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003382 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003383 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3385 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3386 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3387 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3388 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3389 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3390 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003391
3392 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3393 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3394 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3395 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3396 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3397 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3398 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3399 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3400 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003401 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003402 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3403 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3404 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003406 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3407 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3408 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003409 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3410 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3411 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3412 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003413 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3414 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3415 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003416
3417 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3418 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3419 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3420 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3421 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3422 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3423 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3424 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3425 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3426
3427 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3428 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3429 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3430 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3431 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3432 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3433 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3434 persistence cookie in the cache.
3435 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3436
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003437 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3438 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3439 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3440 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3441 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003442 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003443 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3444 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3445 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3446 they logout.
3447
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003448 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3449 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3450 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3451 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3452
3453 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3454 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3455 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3456 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3457 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3458 this attribute.
3459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003460 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003461 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003462 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3463 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3464 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3465 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3466 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3467 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003468
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003469 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3470 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3471 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3472 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3473 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3474 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3475 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3476 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003477 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003478 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3479 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3480 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3481 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3482 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3483 the site.
3484
3485 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3486 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3487 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3488 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3489 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3490 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3491 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3492 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3493 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3494 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3495 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3496 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3497 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003498 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003499 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3500 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3501
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003502 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3503 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3504 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3505 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3506 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3507 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3510 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3511 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3512 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003513
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 Examples :
3515 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3516 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3517 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003518 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003520 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003521
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003522
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003523declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3524 Declares a capture slot.
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 no | yes | yes | no
3527 Arguments:
3528 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3529
3530 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3531 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3532 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3533 for use in the response.
3534
3535 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003536 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003537 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3538
3539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003540default-server [param*]
3541 Change default options for a server in a backend
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | no | yes | yes
3544 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003545 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3546 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3547 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3548 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003550 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003551 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3552
3553 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556default_backend <backend>
3557 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | yes | yes | no
3560 Arguments :
3561 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3562
3563 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3564 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3565 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3566 will catch all undetermined requests.
3567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003568 Example :
3569
3570 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3571 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3572 default_backend dynamic
3573
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003574 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003577description <string>
3578 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 no | yes | yes | yes
3581 Arguments : string
3582
3583 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3584 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3585 it describes.
3586 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3587
3588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589disabled
3590 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | yes
3593 Arguments : none
3594
3595 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3596 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3597 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3598 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3599 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3600 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3601 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3602
3603 See also : "enabled"
3604
3605
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003606dispatch <address>:<port>
3607 Set a default server address
3608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3609 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003610 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003611
3612 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3613 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3614 during start-up.
3615
3616 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3617 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3618 possible with normal servers.
3619
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003620 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003621 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3622 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3623 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3624 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3625
3626 See also : "server"
3627
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003628
3629dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3630 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | no | yes | yes
3633 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3634
3635 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003636 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3638 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003639 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003640 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003641
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003642enabled
3643 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | yes | yes | yes
3646 Arguments : none
3647
3648 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3649 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3650
3651 See also : "disabled"
3652
3653
3654errorfile <code> <file>
3655 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | yes
3658 Arguments :
3659 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003660 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3661 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
3663 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003664 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003666 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3667 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
3669 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3670 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3671 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3672
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003673 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3676 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3677 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3678 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3679
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003680 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3681 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003682 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003683 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3684 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3685 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3688 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3689 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003690 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003691 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3692
3693 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3694
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003695 Example :
3696 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003697 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003698 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3699 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701
3702errorloc <code> <url>
3703errorloc302 <code> <url>
3704 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3706 yes | yes | yes | yes
3707 Arguments :
3708 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003709 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3710 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003711
3712 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3713 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3714 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3715 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003716 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003717
3718 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3719 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3720 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3721
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003722 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003724 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3725 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3726 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3727 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003728 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003729 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3730 request.
3731
3732 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3733
3734
3735errorloc303 <code> <url>
3736 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | yes | yes | yes
3739 Arguments :
3740 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003741 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3742 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003743
3744 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3745 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3746 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3747 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003748 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003749
3750 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3751 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3752 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3753
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003754 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3755
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003756 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3757 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3758 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3759 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003760 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003761
3762 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3763
3764
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003765email-alert from <emailaddr>
3766 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003767 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 yes | yes | yes | yes
3770
3771 Arguments :
3772
3773 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3774
3775 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3776 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3777
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003778 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003779 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3780 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003781
3782
3783email-alert level <level>
3784 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3785 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788
3789 Arguments :
3790
3791 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3792 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3793 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3794
3795 By default level is alert
3796
3797 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3798 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3799 for the proxy.
3800
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003801 Alerts are sent when :
3802
3803 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3804 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3805 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3806 is notice or lower
3807 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3808 and a health check status update occurs
3809
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003810 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3811 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003812 section 3.6 about mailers.
3813
3814
3815email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3816 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3818 yes | yes | yes | yes
3819
3820 Arguments :
3821
3822 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3823
3824 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3825 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3826
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003827 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3828 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003829
3830
3831email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3832 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3833 mailers.
3834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3835 yes | yes | yes | yes
3836
3837 Arguments :
3838
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003839 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003840
3841 By default the systems hostname is used.
3842
3843 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3844 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3845 for the proxy.
3846
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003847 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3848 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850
3851email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003852 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003853 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | yes | yes | yes
3856
3857 Arguments :
3858
3859 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3860
3861 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3862 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3863
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003864 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003865 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3866
3867
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003868force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3869 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003871 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003872
3873 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3874 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3875 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3876 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3877 marked down for maintenance operations.
3878
3879 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3880 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3881 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3882 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3883 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3884 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3885 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3886 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3887 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3888
3889 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3890 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3891 is used.
3892
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003893 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003894 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003895
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003896
3897filter <name> [param*]
3898 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 no | yes | yes | yes
3901 Arguments :
3902 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3903 referenced in section 9.
3904
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003905 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003906 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003907 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3908 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003909
3910 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3911 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3912
3913 Example:
3914 listen
3915 bind *:80
3916
3917 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3918 filter compression
3919 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3920
3921 compression algo gzip
3922 compression offload
3923
3924 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3925
3926 See also : section 9.
3927
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003929fullconn <conns>
3930 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 yes | no | yes | yes
3933 Arguments :
3934 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3935 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3936
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003937 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003939 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003940 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3941 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3942 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3943 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3944 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003945 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003947 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3948 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003949 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3950 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3951 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003952
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003953 Example :
3954 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3955 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3956 # connections.
3957 backend dynamic
3958 fullconn 10000
3959 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3960 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3961
3962 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3963
3964
3965grace <time>
3966 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003969 Arguments :
3970 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3971 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3972 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3973
3974 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3975 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003977 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3978
3979 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3980 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3981 simplify it.
3982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003983
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003984hash-balance-factor <factor>
3985 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | no | yes
3988 Arguments :
3989 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3990 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003991 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003992
3993 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3994 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3995 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3996 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3997 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3998 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3999 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4000
4001 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4002 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4003 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4004 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4005 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4006
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004007 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4008 consistent hashing mechanism.
4009
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004010 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4011
4012
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004013hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004014 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4016 yes | no | yes | yes
4017 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004018 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4019 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004020
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004021 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4022 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4023 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4024 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4025 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4026 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4027 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4028 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4029 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4030 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004031
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004032 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4033 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4034 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4035 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4036 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4037 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4038 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4039 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4040 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4041 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4042 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4043 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4044 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004045 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4046 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004047
4048 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4049
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004050 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004051 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4052 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4053 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4055 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4056 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004057
4058 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4059 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004060 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4061 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4062 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4063 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4064
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004065 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4066 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4067 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4068 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4069 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4070 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4071 parameter.
4072
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004073 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4074 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4075 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4076 used on strings.
4077
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004078 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4079
4080 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4081 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4082 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4083 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4084 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4085 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4086 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4087 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4088 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4089 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4090 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4091 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004092
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004093 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4094 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4095 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004096
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004097 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004098
4099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004100http-check disable-on-404
4101 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004103 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104 Arguments : none
4105
4106 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4107 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4108 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4109 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4110 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4111 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4112 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4113 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004114 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4115 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4116 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4117
4118 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4119
4120
4121http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004122 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004124 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004125 Arguments :
4126 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4127 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004128 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004129 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4130 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4131 details on the supported keywords.
4132
4133 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4134 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4135 with the usual backslash ('\').
4136
4137 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4138 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4139 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4140 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4141 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4142
4143 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004144 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004145 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4146 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4147 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4148
4149 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004150 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004151 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4152 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4153 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4154 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4155
4156 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004157 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004158 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4159 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4160 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4161 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4162 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004163 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004164 trace).
4165
4166 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004167 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004168 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4169 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4170 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4171 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4172 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004173 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004174
4175 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4176 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4177 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4178 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4179 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4180 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4181 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4182 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4183
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004184 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4185 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4186 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4187
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004188 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4189 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4190
4191 Examples :
4192 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004193 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004194
4195 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004196 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197
4198 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004199 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004200
4201 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004202 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004203
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004204 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004205
4206
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004207http-check send-state
4208 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4210 yes | no | yes | yes
4211 Arguments : none
4212
4213 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4214 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4215 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4216 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4217 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4218
4219 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4220 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4221 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4222 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4223 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004224 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4225 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4226 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4227
4228 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4229 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4230 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4231
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004232 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4233 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4234 checked in multiple backends.
4235
4236 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4237 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4238
4239 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4240 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4241 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4242 one fails.
4243
4244 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4245 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4246 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4247
4248 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4249 server's queue.
4250
4251 Example of a header received by the application server :
4252 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4253 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4254
4255 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257
4258http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004259 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4260
4261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 no | yes | yes | yes
4263
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004264 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4265 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4266 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4267 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4268 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4271 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4276 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4277 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4278 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4281 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4282 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4283 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285 Example:
4286 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4287 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4288 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 http-request allow if nagios
4291 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4292 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4293 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 Example:
4296 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4297 acl add path /addacl
4298 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004301
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004302 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4303 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305 Example:
4306 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4307 acl setmap path /setmap
4308 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4313 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004315 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4316 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4321 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4322 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4323 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4324 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4325 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4326 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4327 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4332 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4333 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4334 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4335 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4336 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4337 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4338 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4343 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4349 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4350 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4351 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4352 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354 Example:
4355 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4356 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004357
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004358http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4363 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4366 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4367 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4368 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4369 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4370 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4371 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4372 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4373 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4376 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4377 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4378 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4379 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4380 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4385 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4386 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4387 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4388 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4389 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4398 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4399 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4400 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4401 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4402 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4407 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4408 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4409 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4410 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004411
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004412http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4413 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4414 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4415 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4416
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004417http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4418
4419 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4420 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4421 pointed by <resolvers>.
4422 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4423 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4424 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4425 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4426 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4427 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4428 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4429 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4430 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4431 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4432 to 0.0.0.0.
4433
4434 Example:
4435 resolvers mydns
4436 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4437 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4438 timeout retry 1s
4439 hold valid 10s
4440 hold nx 3s
4441 hold other 3s
4442 hold obsolete 0s
4443 accepted_payload_size 8192
4444
4445 frontend fe
4446 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4447 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4448 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4449
4450 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4451 # which mean DNS resolution error
4452 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4453
4454 default_backend be
4455
4456 backend b_503
4457 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4458 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4459 # 503 error page to end users
4460
4461 backend be
4462 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4463 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4464 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4465 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4466 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4467
4468 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4469 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4470
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004471http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4472
4473 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4474 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4475 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4476 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004477 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4478 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004479
4480 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4485 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4486 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4487 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4488 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4493 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4494 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4495 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004499
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004500 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4501 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4502 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4503 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4504 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4505 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004506
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004507 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4508 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4509 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4510 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4511 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004512
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004513 Example:
4514 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4515
4516 # applied to:
4517 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4518
4519 # outputs:
4520 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4521
4522 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004523
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004524 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4525
4526 # applied to:
4527 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004528
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004529 # outputs:
4530 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004531
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004532http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4534
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004535 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4536 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4537 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4538 against.
4539
4540 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4541 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4542 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004543
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004544 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4545 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4546 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4547 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4548 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4549 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4550 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4551 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4552 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
4553 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004554
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004555 Example:
4556 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4557 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004558
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004559 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4560 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004564
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004565 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4566 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4567 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4568 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004569
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004570 Example:
4571 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004572
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004573 # applied to:
4574 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004575
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004576 # outputs:
4577 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4580http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4583 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4584 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4589 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4590 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4595 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4596 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4597 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4598 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600 Arguments:
4601 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4602 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604 Example:
4605 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4606 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4609 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4614 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4615 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 Arguments:
4618 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4619 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 Example:
4622 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4623 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4626 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4627 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4632 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4633 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4634 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4635 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 Example:
4638 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4639 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4642 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4643 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4644 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4645 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4646 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4651 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4652 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4653 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4654 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4657 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4660 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4661 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4662 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4663 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4664 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4665 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4666 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4667 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4672 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4673 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4674 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4675 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4676 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4677 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004681 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4682 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4683 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4688 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4689 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4690 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4691 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4692 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4693 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4694 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4699 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4700 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4701 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4702 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4703 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004705 Example :
4706 # prepend the host name before the path
4707 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004709http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004711 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4712 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4713 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4714 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4715 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4720 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4721 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4722 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4723 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4724 values have higher priority.
4725 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4726 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4727 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4728 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4729 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004731http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4734 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4735 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4736 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4737 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4738 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4739 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004742
4743 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004744 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4745 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004747http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4748 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4749 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4750 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4751 privacy.
4752
4753 Arguments :
4754 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4755 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004756
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004757 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4759 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4760
4761 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4762 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4763
4764http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4765
4766 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4767 expression.
4768
4769 Arguments:
4770 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4771 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004772
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004773 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004774 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4775 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4776
4777 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4778 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4779 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4780
4781http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4782
4783 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4784 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4785 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4786 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4787 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4788 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4789 information from the request.
4790
4791 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4792
4793http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4794
4795 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4796 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4797 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4798 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4799 path and the query string.
4800 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4801
4802http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4803
4804 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4805 inline.
4806
4807 Arguments:
4808 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4809 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4810 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4811 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4812 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4813 (request and response)
4814 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4815 processing
4816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4817 processing
4818 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4819 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4820 and '_'.
4821
4822 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4823 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004824
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004825 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004826 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004828http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4829 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004830
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004831 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4832 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4833 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4834 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4835 agent name must be used.
4836
4837 Arguments:
4838 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4839
4840 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4841 configuration.
4842
4843http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4844
4845 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4846 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4847 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4848 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4849 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4850 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4851 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4852 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4853 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4854 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4855 action.
4856 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4857 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4858 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4859 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4860 you fully understand how it works.
4861
4862http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4863
4864 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4865 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4866 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4867 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4868 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4869 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4870 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4871 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4872 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4873 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4874 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4875 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4876 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4877
4878http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4879http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4880http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4881
4882 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4883 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4884 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4885 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4886 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4887 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4888 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4889 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4890 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4891 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4892 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4893 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4894
4895 Arguments :
4896 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4897 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4898 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4899 select which table entry to update the counters.
4900
4901 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4902 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4903 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4904 that table until the session ends.
4905
4906 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4907 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4908 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4909 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4910 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4911 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4912 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4913 useful information.
4914
4915 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4916 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4917 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4918 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4919 checks that make use of it.
4920
4921http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4922
4923 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004924
4925 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004926 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004927
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004928http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4929
4930 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4931 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4932 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4933 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4934 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4935 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4936
4937 Arguments :
4938 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4939
4940 Example:
4941 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004943http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004945 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4946 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4947 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004948
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004951 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4952
4953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4954 no | yes | yes | yes
4955
4956 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4957 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4958 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4959 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4960 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4961 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4964 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4969 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4970 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4971 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4974 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4975 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4976 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 Example:
4979 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004983 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4984 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986 Example:
4987 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004989 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4992 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4995 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004997http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004999 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5000 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5001 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5002 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5003 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5004 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5005 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5006 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005008http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5011 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5012 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5013 example, or to pass some internal information.
5014 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5015 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5016 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5021 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005022
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005023http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005025 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5030 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5031 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5032 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5033 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5034 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5035 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5038 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5039 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5040 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5041 keyword.
5042 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5043 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5048 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5049 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5050 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5051 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5052 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005056 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005058http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5061 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5062 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5063 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5064 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5065 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5070 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005072http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005074 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5075 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5076 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5077 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5078 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5079 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5082 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005083
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005084 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5085 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087 Example:
5088 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005090 # applied to:
5091 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005093 # outputs:
5094 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005100
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005101 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5102 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005104 Example:
5105 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 # applied to:
5108 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005110 # outputs:
5111 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005113http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5114http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5117 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5118 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005122 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5123 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5124 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5129 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5130 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5131 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5132 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005134 Arguments:
5135 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5138 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005142 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5143 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5144 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5147
5148 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5149 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5150 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5151 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5152 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5153
5154http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5155
5156 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5157 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5158 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5159 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5160 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5161 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5162 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5163 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5164 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5165
5166http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5167
5168 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5169 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5170 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5171 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5172 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5173 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5174 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5175
5176http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5177
5178 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5179 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5180 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5181 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5182 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5183 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5184 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5185 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5186
5187http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5188 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5189
5190 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5191 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5192 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5193 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005194
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005195 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5197 http-response set-status 431
5198 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5199 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005201http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005203 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5204 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5205 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5206 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5207 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5208 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5209 based on some information from the request.
5210
5211 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5212
5213http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5214
5215 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5216 inline.
5217
5218 Arguments:
5219 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5220 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5221 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5222 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5223 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5224 (request and response)
5225 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5226 processing
5227 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5228 processing
5229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5230 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5231 and '_'.
5232
5233 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5234 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005235
5236 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005237 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005239http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005240
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005241 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5242 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5243 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5244 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5245 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5246 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5247 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5248 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5249 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5250 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5251 action.
5252 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5253 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5254 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5255 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5256 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005257
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005258http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5259http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5260http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005262 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5263 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5264 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5265 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5266 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5267 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5268
5269http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5270
5271 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5272 about <var-name>.
5273
5274 Example:
5275 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5276
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005277
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005278http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5279 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5280
5281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 yes | no | yes | yes
5283
5284 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005285 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5286 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5287 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005288
5289 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5290
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005291 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5292 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5293 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5294 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5295 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5296 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5297 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5298 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5299 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5300 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005301
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005302 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5303 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5304 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5305 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5306 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5307 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5308 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5309 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005310
5311 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5312 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5313 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5314 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5315 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5316 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5317 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5318 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005319 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005320 downsides of rare connection failures.
5321
5322 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5323 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5324 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5325 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5326 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5327 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005328 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005329 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5330 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5331 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5332 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5333 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5334
5335 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005336 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5337 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5338 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005339
5340 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005341 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005342
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005343 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5344 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005345
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005346 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005347
5348 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5349 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5350 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5351
5352 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5353
5354
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005355http-send-name-header [<header>]
5356 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005359 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005360 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5361
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005362 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5363 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5364 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5365 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5366 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5367 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5368 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5369 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5370 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5371 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5372 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5373 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5374 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5375 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5376 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5377 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005378
5379 See also : "server"
5380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005381id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005382 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 no | yes | yes | yes
5385 Arguments : none
5386
5387 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5388 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5389 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005390
5391
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005392ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5393 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005395 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005396
5397 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5398 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5399 and running).
5400
5401 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5402 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5403 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005404 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005405 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5406
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005407 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5408 "unless" condition is met.
5409
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005410 Example:
5411 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5412 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5413 ignore-persist if url_static
5414
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005415 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5416
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005417load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5418 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | no | yes | yes
5421
5422 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5423 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5424 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005425 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005426 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5427 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5428 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5429 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005431 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005432 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005433 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005434
5435 Arguments:
5436 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5437 named "server-state-file".
5438
5439 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5440 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5441 name is used as a file name.
5442
5443 none don't load any stat for this backend
5444
5445 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005446 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5447 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5448 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005449 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005450 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005451
5452 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5453 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5454
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005455 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005456
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005457 global
5458 stats socket /tmp/socket
5459 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005460
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005461 defaults
5462 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005463
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005464 backend bk
5465 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5466 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005467
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005468
5469 Then one can run :
5470
5471 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5472
5473 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5474
5475 1
5476 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5477 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5478 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5479
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005480 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005481
5482 global
5483 stats socket /tmp/socket
5484 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5485
5486 defaults
5487 load-server-state-from-file local
5488
5489 backend bk
5490 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5491 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5492
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005493
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005494 Then one can run :
5495
5496 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5497
5498 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5499
5500 1
5501 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5502 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5503 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5504
5505 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5506 "show servers state"
5507
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005509log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005510log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5511 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005512no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005516
5517 Prefix :
5518 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5519 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5520 prefix does not allow arguments.
5521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005522 Arguments :
5523 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5524 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5525 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5526 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5527 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5528 parameter.
5529
5530 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5531 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5532
5533 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5534 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5535 standard syslog port).
5536
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005537 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5538 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5539 standard syslog port).
5540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005541 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5542 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5543 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005544 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005545
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005546 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5547 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5548 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5549 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5550 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5551 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5552 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5553 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5554 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5555 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5556 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5557 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5558 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5559 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5560 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5561 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005562 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5563 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005564
5565 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5566 and "fd@2", see above.
5567
5568 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5569 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005570
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005571 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5572 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5573 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5574 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5575 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5576 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5577 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5578 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5579 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5580 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005581 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005582
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005583 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5584 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5585 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5586 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5587 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5588
5589 <sample_size>
5590 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5591 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5592 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5593 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5594 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5595
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005596 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5597 one of the following :
5598
5599 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5600 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5601
5602 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5603 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5604
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005605 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5606 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5607 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5608 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5609 systemd logger consumes.
5610
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005611 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5612 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5613 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5614 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5615
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005616 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5617
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005618 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5619 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5620 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5621
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005622 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5623 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5624 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5625 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005626
5627 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5628 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5629 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005630 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5631 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5632 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5633 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5634 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005635
5636 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5637
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005638 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5639 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5640 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005641
5642 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5643 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5644 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5645 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5646
5647 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5648 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005649
5650 Example :
5651 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005652 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5653 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5654 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005655 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5656 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005657 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005658
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005660log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005661 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005664
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005665 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5666 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5667 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5668 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5669 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005670
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005671 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5672 "option httplog" directives.
5673
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005674log-format-sd <string>
5675 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | yes | yes | no
5678
5679 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5680 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5681 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5682 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5683 which covers the log format string in depth.
5684
5685 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5686 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5687
5688 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5689 log format to "rfc5424".
5690
5691 Example :
5692 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5693
5694
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005695log-tag <string>
5696 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5698 yes | yes | yes | yes
5699
5700 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5701 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5702 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5703 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5704 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5705 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5706 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5707 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5708 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005709
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005710max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5711 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | no | yes | yes
5714
5715 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5716 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5717 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5718 servers.
5719
5720 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5721 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5722 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5723 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5724 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005725 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005726 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5727 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5728 picking a different server.
5729
5730 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5731 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5732 even if they have to be queued.
5733
5734 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5735 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5736
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005737max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5738 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5739 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5740 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005741
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005742maxconn <conns>
5743 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | yes | yes | no
5746 Arguments :
5747 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5748 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5749 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5750 closes.
5751
5752 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5753 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5754 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5755 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005756 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5757 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5758 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5759 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005760
5761 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5762 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5763 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5764
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005765 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5766 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005768 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5769
5770
5771mode { tcp|http|health }
5772 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | yes
5775 Arguments :
5776 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5777 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5778 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5779 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5780
5781 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5782 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5783 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5784 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5785 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5786
5787 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005788 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5789 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5790 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5791 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5792 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5793 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5794 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005795
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005796 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5797 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5798 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005800 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005801 defaults http_instances
5802 mode http
5803
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005804 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005806
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005807monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005808 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005811 Arguments :
5812 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5813 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005814 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005815 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5816 backend and its backup.
5817
5818 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5819 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5820 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5821 servers in a list of backends.
5822
5823 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5824 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5825 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5826 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5827 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5828 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5829 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005830 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5831 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005832
5833 Example:
5834 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005835 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005836 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5837 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5838 monitor-uri /site_alive
5839 monitor fail if site_dead
5840
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005841 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005842
5843
5844monitor-net <source>
5845 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | yes | yes | no
5848 Arguments :
5849 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5850 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5851 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5852 followed by a mask.
5853
5854 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5855 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005856 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005857 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5858
5859 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5860 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5861 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5862 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005863 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5864 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5865 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005866
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005867 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5868 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5869 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5870 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5871 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5872 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005873
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005874 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5875 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005876
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005877 Example :
5878 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5879 frontend www
5880 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5881
5882 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5883
5884
5885monitor-uri <uri>
5886 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | yes | yes | no
5889 Arguments :
5890 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5891 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5892
5893 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5894 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5895 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5896 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5897 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5898 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5899 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5900 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5901
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005902 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5903 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5904 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5905 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5906 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5907 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5908 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5909 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005910
5911 Example :
5912 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5913 frontend www
5914 mode http
5915 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5916
5917 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005919
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005920option abortonclose
5921no option abortonclose
5922 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5924 yes | no | yes | yes
5925 Arguments : none
5926
5927 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5928 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5929 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5930 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005931 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005932 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5933 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5934 encountered while delivering the response.
5935
5936 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5937 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5938 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5939 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5940 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5941 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005942 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005943 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005944 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005945 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5946 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5947 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5948
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005949 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5950 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005951 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5952 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5953 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5954 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5955 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5956 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005957 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005958
5959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5961
5962 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5963
5964
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005965option accept-invalid-http-request
5966no option accept-invalid-http-request
5967 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 yes | yes | yes | no
5970 Arguments : none
5971
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005972 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005973 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005974 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005975 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5976 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5977 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5978 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5979 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005980 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5981 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5982 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5983 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005984 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005985 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005986 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5987 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5988 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005989
5990 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5991 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5992 been confirmed.
5993
5994 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5995 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005996 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5997 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005998 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5999
6000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6002
6003 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6004 stats socket.
6005
6006
6007option accept-invalid-http-response
6008no option accept-invalid-http-response
6009 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 yes | no | yes | yes
6012 Arguments : none
6013
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006014 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006015 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006016 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006017 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6018 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6019 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6020 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6021 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006022 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6023 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6024 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006025
6026 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6027 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6028 been confirmed.
6029
6030 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6031 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6032 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6033 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6034
6035 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6036 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6037
6038 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6039 stats socket.
6040
6041
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006042option allbackups
6043no option allbackups
6044 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | no | yes | yes
6047 Arguments : none
6048
6049 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6050 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6051 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6052 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6053 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6054 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6055 order between the backup servers anymore.
6056
6057 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6058 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6059
6060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6062
6063
6064option checkcache
6065no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006066 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | no | yes | yes
6069 Arguments : none
6070
6071 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6072 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006073 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006074 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6075 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006076 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006077
6078 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006079 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006080 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006081 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6082 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006083 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006084 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006085 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6086 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006087 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006088 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6089 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006090 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006091 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6092 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6093 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6094 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6095 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6096 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6097 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6098 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6099 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6100
6101 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006102 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006103 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006104 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006105 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6106
6107 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6108 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006109 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006110 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006111
6112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6114
6115
6116option clitcpka
6117no option clitcpka
6118 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6120 yes | yes | yes | no
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6124 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006125 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006126 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6127
6128 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6129 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6130 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6131 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6132
6133 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6134 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6135 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6136 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6137 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6138
6139 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6140
6141 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6142 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6143 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6144
6145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6147
6148 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6149
6150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006151option contstats
6152 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6154 yes | yes | yes | no
6155 Arguments : none
6156
6157 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6158 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6159 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6160 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006161 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6162 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6163 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6164 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6165 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006166
6167
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006168option dontlog-normal
6169no option dontlog-normal
6170 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 yes | yes | yes | no
6173 Arguments : none
6174
6175 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6176 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6177 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6178 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6179 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6180 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6181 logged.
6182
6183 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6184 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6185 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006187 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006188 logging.
6189
6190
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006191option dontlognull
6192no option dontlognull
6193 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6195 yes | yes | yes | no
6196 Arguments : none
6197
6198 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6199 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6200 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6201 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6202 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6203 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006204 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6205 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6206 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006207
6208 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006209 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006210 would not be logged.
6211
6212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6214
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006215 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6216 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006217
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006218
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006219option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006220 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 yes | yes | yes | yes
6223 Arguments :
6224 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6225 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006226 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006227 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006228
6229 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6230 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6231 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6232 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6233 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6234 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6235 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006236 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6237 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6238 possible that the client has already brought one.
6239
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006240 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006241 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006242 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006243 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006244 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006245 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006246
6247 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6248 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6249 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6250 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6251 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6252 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6253 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6254
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006255 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6256 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6257 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6258 are under the control of the end-user.
6259
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006260 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006261 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6262 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006263 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6264 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6265 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006266
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006267 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006268 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6269 frontend www
6270 mode http
6271 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6272
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006273 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6274 backend www
6275 mode http
6276 option forwardfor header X-Client
6277
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006278 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006279 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006280
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006281
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006282option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6283no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6284 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6286 yes | yes | yes | no
6287 Arguments : none
6288
6289 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6290 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6291 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6292 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6293 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6294 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6295 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6296
6297 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6298 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6299 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6300 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6301 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6302 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6303 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6304 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6305 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6306 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6307
6308 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6309
6310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6312
6313 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6314 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6315
6316
6317option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6318no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6319 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | no | yes | yes
6322 Arguments : none
6323
6324 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6325 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6326 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6327 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6328 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6329 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6330 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6331
6332 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6333 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6334 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6335 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6336 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6337 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6338 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6339 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6340 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6341 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6342
6343 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6344
6345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6347
6348 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6349 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6350
6351
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006352option http-buffer-request
6353no option http-buffer-request
6354 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 yes | yes | yes | yes
6357 Arguments : none
6358
6359 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6360 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6361 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6362 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6363 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6364 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6365 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6366 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006367 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006368 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6369 default.
6370
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006371 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006372
6373
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006374option http-ignore-probes
6375no option http-ignore-probes
6376 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | yes | yes | no
6379 Arguments : none
6380
6381 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6382 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6383 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6384 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6385 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6386 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6387 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6388 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6389 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006390 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6391 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006392 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6393
6394 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6395 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6396 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6397 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6398 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6399 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6400 are often the only way to detect them.
6401
6402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6404
6405 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6406
6407
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006408option http-keep-alive
6409no option http-keep-alive
6410 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6412 yes | yes | yes | yes
6413 Arguments : none
6414
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006415 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6416 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006417 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6418 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6419 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6420 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6421 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006422
6423 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6424 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006425 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6426 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6427 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6428 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6429 situations where this option may be useful :
6430
6431 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006432 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006433
6434 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6435 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6436
6437 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6438 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6439 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6440 request.
6441
6442 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6443 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006444 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6445 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6446 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006447
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006448 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6449 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6450 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6451 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6452 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6453 not set.
6454
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006455 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006456 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6457 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006459 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006460 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006461 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006462
6463
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006464option http-no-delay
6465no option http-no-delay
6466 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | yes | yes | yes
6469 Arguments : none
6470
6471 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6472 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6473 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6474 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6475 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6476 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6477 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6478 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6479 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6480 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6481 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6482 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6483 affected.
6484
6485 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6486 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6487 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6488 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6489 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6490 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6491 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6492 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6493 latency environments.
6494
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006495 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6496
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006497
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006498option http-pretend-keepalive
6499no option http-pretend-keepalive
6500 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006502 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006503 Arguments : none
6504
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006505 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006506 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6507 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6508 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6509 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6510 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6511 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6512 consider the response complete.
6513
6514 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6515 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6516 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6517 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006518 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006519 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6520
6521 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6522 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6523 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6524 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6525 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6526 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6527 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6528
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006529 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6530 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6531 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6532 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6533 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6534 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006535
6536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6538
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006539 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006540 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006541
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006542
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006543option http-server-close
6544no option http-server-close
6545 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6547 yes | yes | yes | yes
6548 Arguments : none
6549
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006550 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6551 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6552 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6553 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006554 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6555 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6556 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6557 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6558 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6559 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6560 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6561 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6562 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6563 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6564 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006565
6566 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6567 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6568 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6569 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006570 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6571 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006572
6573 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6574 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006575 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6576 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6577 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006578
6579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6581
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006582 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6583 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006584
6585
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006586option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6587no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6588 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006590 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006591 Arguments : none
6592
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006593 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6594 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6595 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6596
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006597 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6598 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6599 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6600 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006601 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006602
6603 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006604 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006605 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6606 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6607 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6608 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6609 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6610 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6611 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006612
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006613 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6614 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6615 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6616 backend.
6617
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6620
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006621 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6622 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006623
6624
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006625option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006626no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006627 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6629 yes | yes | yes | no
6630 Arguments : none
6631
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006632 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006633 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6634 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6635 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6636 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6637 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6638 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6639
6640 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6641 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006642 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6643 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6644 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006645
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006646 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6647 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6648 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6649 front of an existing proxy.
6650
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006651 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6652
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006653 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006654
6655
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006656option http-use-htx
6657no option http-use-htx
6658 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | yes | yes | yes
6661 Arguments : none
6662
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006663 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006664 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006665 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6666 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6667 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6668 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6669 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006670
6671 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6672 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6673 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6674 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006675 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6676 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6677 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6678 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006679
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006680 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6681 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6682 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6683 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6684 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006685
6686 See also : "mode http"
6687
6688
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006689option httpchk
6690option httpchk <uri>
6691option httpchk <method> <uri>
6692option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6693 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | no | yes | yes
6696 Arguments :
6697 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6698 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6699 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6700 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6701 ones.
6702
6703 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6704 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6705 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6706
6707 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6708 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6709 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6710 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6711 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6712
6713 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6714 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6715 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6716 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6717 the lack of any response.
6718
6719 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6720
6721 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6722 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6723 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6724
6725 Examples :
6726 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6727 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6728 backend https_relay
6729 mode tcp
6730 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6731 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6732
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006733 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6734 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6735 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006736
6737
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006738option httpclose
6739no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006740 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | yes | yes | yes
6743 Arguments : none
6744
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006745 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6746 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6747 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6748 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006749 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006750
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006751 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6752 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006753 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006754 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6755 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006756
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006757 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6758 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6759 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006760
6761 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6762 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006763 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006764 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6765 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6766 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006767
6768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6770
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006771 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006772
6773
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006774option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006775 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006777 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006778 Arguments :
6779 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6780 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6781 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006782 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006783 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006784
6785 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6786 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6787 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6788 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6789 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6790 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6791 ports.
6792
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006793 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6794 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006795
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006796 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006798 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006799
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006800
6801option http_proxy
6802no option http_proxy
6803 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | yes | yes | yes
6806 Arguments : none
6807
6808 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6809 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6810 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6811 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6812 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6813
6814 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6815 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006816 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6817 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006818
6819 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6820 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6821
6822 Example :
6823 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6824 backend direct_forward
6825 option httpclose
6826 option http_proxy
6827
6828 See also : "option httpclose"
6829
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006830
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006831option independent-streams
6832no option independent-streams
6833 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 yes | yes | yes | yes
6836 Arguments : none
6837
6838 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6839 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6840 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6841 receive data or not.
6842
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006843 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006844 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6845 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6846 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6847 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6848 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6849 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6850 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6851 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6852 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6853 socket buffers.
6854
6855 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6856 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6857 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6858 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6859 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6860
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006861 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006862 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6863 deprecated.
6864
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006865 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006866
6867
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006868option ldap-check
6869 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6871 yes | no | yes | yes
6872 Arguments : none
6873
6874 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6875 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6876 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6877 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6878
6879 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6880 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6881
6882 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6883 configure it.
6884
6885 Example :
6886 option ldap-check
6887
6888 See also : "option httpchk"
6889
6890
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006891option external-check
6892 Use external processes for server health checks
6893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6894 yes | no | yes | yes
6895
6896 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6897 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6898 command".
6899
6900 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6901
6902 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6903
6904
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006905option log-health-checks
6906no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006907 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 yes | no | yes | yes
6910 Arguments : none
6911
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006912 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6913 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6914 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006915
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006916 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6917 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6918 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6919 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6920 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006923 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006924
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006925 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6926 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6927 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006928
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006929
6930option log-separate-errors
6931no option log-separate-errors
6932 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6934 yes | yes | yes | no
6935 Arguments : none
6936
6937 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6938 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6939 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6940 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6941 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6942 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6943 provides very important information.
6944
6945 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6946 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6947 error logs.
6948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006949 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006950 logging.
6951
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006952
6953option logasap
6954no option logasap
6955 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 yes | yes | yes | no
6958 Arguments : none
6959
6960 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6961 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6962 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6963 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6964 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6965 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6966 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006967 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006968 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6969 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6970
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006971 Examples :
6972 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6973 mode http
6974 option httplog
6975 option logasap
6976 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6977
6978 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6979 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6980 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6981 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006983 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006984 logging.
6985
6986
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006987option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006988 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006991 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006992 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6993 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006994 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006995
6996 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6997 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006998 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006999 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7000 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7001 in the MySQL table, like this :
7002
7003 USE mysql;
7004 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7005 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7006
7007 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007008 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007009 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7010 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7011 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7012 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7013 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7014 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7015 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7016
7017 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7018 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007019
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007020 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007021
7022 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7023 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7024 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7025 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007026 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7027 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007028
7029 See also: "option httpchk"
7030
7031
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007032option nolinger
7033no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007034 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007037 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007039 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007040 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7041 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7042 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7043 connections.
7044
7045 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7046 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7047 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7048 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7049 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7050 this too.
7051
7052 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7053 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7054 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7055
7056 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7057 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7058 for servers.
7059
7060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7062
7063
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007064option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7065 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 yes | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments :
7069 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7070 matching <network>
7071 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7072 header name.
7073
7074 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7075 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7076 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7077 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7078 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7079 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7080 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7081 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7082 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7083 possible that the client has already brought one.
7084
7085 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7086 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7087 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7088 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7089 header and requires different one.
7090
7091 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7092 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7093 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7094 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7095 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7096 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7097 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7098
7099 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7100 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7101 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7102 both are defined.
7103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007104 Examples :
7105 # Original Destination address
7106 frontend www
7107 mode http
7108 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7109
7110 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7111 backend www
7112 mode http
7113 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7114
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007115 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007116
7117
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007118option persist
7119no option persist
7120 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007123 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007124
7125 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7126 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7127 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7128 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7129 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7130 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7131 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7132 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7133 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7134 redirected to another valid server.
7135
7136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7138
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007139 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007140
7141
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007142option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7143 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 yes | no | yes | yes
7146 Arguments :
7147 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7148 PostgreSQL server.
7149
7150 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7151 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7152 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7153 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7154
7155 See also: "option httpchk"
7156
7157
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007158option prefer-last-server
7159no option prefer-last-server
7160 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7162 yes | no | yes | yes
7163 Arguments : none
7164
7165 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7166 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7167 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7168 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7169 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7170 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7171 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7172 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7173 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007174 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7175 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007176 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7177 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7178 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007179 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7180 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7181 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007182
7183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7185
7186 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7187
7188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007189option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007190option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007191no option redispatch
7192 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7194 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007195 Arguments :
7196 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7197 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7198 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007199 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007200 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007201 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007202 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7203 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7204 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007206
7207 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7208 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7209 be able to access the service anymore.
7210
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007211 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7212 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007213
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007214 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007215 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7216 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007218 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7219 "redisp" keywords.
7220
7221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7223
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007224 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007225
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007226
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007227option redis-check
7228 Use redis health checks for server testing
7229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7230 yes | no | yes | yes
7231 Arguments : none
7232
7233 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7234 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7235 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7236 find the "+PONG" response message.
7237
7238 Example :
7239 option redis-check
7240
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007241 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007242
7243
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007244option smtpchk
7245option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7246 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7248 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007249 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007250 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007251 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007252 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7253
7254 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7255 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7256 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7257
7258 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7259 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7260 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7261 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7262 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7263 dead server.
7264
7265 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7266 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007267 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007268 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7269
7270 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7271 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7272 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7273 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007274 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007275
7276 Example :
7277 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7278
7279 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007282option socket-stats
7283no option socket-stats
7284
7285 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7287 yes | yes | yes | no
7288
7289 Arguments : none
7290
7291
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007292option splice-auto
7293no option splice-auto
7294 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 yes | yes | yes | yes
7297 Arguments : none
7298
7299 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7300 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007301 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007302 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007303 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007304 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7305 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7306 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7307 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7308
7309 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7310 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7311 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7312 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7313 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7314 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7315 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7316 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7317 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7318 keyword.
7319
7320 Example :
7321 option splice-auto
7322
7323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7325
7326 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7327 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7328
7329
7330option splice-request
7331no option splice-request
7332 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 yes | yes | yes | yes
7335 Arguments : none
7336
7337 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007338 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007339 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7340 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7341 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7342 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7343
7344 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7345
7346 Example :
7347 option splice-request
7348
7349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7351
7352 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7353 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7354
7355
7356option splice-response
7357no option splice-response
7358 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 yes | yes | yes | yes
7361 Arguments : none
7362
7363 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007364 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007365 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7366 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7367 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7368 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7369
7370 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7371
7372 Example :
7373 option splice-response
7374
7375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7377
7378 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7379 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7380
7381
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007382option spop-check
7383 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7385 no | no | no | yes
7386 Arguments : none
7387
7388 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7389 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7390 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7391 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7392
7393 Example :
7394 option spop-check
7395
7396 See also : "option httpchk"
7397
7398
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007399option srvtcpka
7400no option srvtcpka
7401 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7403 yes | no | yes | yes
7404 Arguments : none
7405
7406 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7407 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007408 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007409 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7410
7411 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7412 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7413 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7414 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7415
7416 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7417 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7418 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7419 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7420 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7421
7422 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7423
7424 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7425 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7426 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7427
7428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7430
7431 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7432
7433
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007434option ssl-hello-chk
7435 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 yes | no | yes | yes
7438 Arguments : none
7439
7440 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7441 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7442 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7443 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7444 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7445 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7446 hello message.
7447
7448 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7449 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7450 messages, which is appreciable.
7451
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007452 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7453 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7454 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007455
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007456 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7457
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007458
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007459option tcp-check
7460 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 yes | no | yes | yes
7463
7464 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7465 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7466
7467 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7468 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7469 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7470
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007471 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007472 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7473 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7474 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7475 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7476 only.
7477
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007478 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007479 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7480 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7481 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7482 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7483
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007484 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007485 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7486 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007487 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007488 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7489 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7490 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7491 the respective protocols.
7492 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007493 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007494
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007495 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7496 script.
7497
7498 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7499 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7500 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7501 The "comment" is of course optional.
7502
7503
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007504 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007505 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007506 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007507 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007508
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007509 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007510 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007511 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007512
7513 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7514 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007515 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007516 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007517 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007518 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007519 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007520 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007521 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7522 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007523 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007524 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7525 tcp-check expect string +OK
7526
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007527 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007528 (send many headers before analyzing)
7529 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007530 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007531 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7532 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7533 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7534 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007535 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007536
7537
7538 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7539
7540
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007541option tcp-smart-accept
7542no option tcp-smart-accept
7543 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7545 yes | yes | yes | no
7546 Arguments : none
7547
7548 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7549 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7550 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7551 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7552 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7553 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7554
7555 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7556 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7557 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7558 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7559
7560 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7561 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7562 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007563 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007564
7565 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7566 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7567 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7568
7569 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7570 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7571 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7572
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007573 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7574
7575
7576option tcp-smart-connect
7577no option tcp-smart-connect
7578 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | no | yes | yes
7581 Arguments : none
7582
7583 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7584 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7585 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7586 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7587 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7588
7589 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7590 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7591 complex.
7592
7593 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7594 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7595 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7596
7597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7599
7600 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7601
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007602
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007603option tcpka
7604 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | yes | yes | yes
7607 Arguments : none
7608
7609 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7610 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007612 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7613
7614 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7615 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7616 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7617 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7618
7619 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7620 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7621 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7622 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7623 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7624
7625 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7626
7627 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7628 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7629 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7630 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7631 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7632 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7633 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7634 backends.
7635
7636 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7637
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007638
7639option tcplog
7640 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007642 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007643 Arguments : none
7644
7645 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7646 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7647 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7648 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7649 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7650 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7651 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7652 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7653
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007654 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007656 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007657
7658
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007659option transparent
7660no option transparent
7661 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007663 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007664 Arguments : none
7665
7666 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7667 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7668 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7669 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7670 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7671 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7672 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7673 appropriate server.
7674
7675 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7676 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7677
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007678 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007679 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007680
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007681
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007682external-check command <command>
7683 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7685 yes | no | yes | yes
7686
7687 Arguments :
7688 <command> is the external command to run
7689
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007690 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7691
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007692 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007693
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007694 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7695 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7696 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7697 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7698 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7699 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007700
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007701 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7702
7703 Environment variables :
7704 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7705 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7706
7707 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7708
7709 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7710
7711 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7712 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7713 for a UNIX socket).
7714
7715 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7716
7717 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7718
7719 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7720
7721 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7722
7723 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7724
7725 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7726 socket).
7727
7728 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7729 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007731 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7732
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007733 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7734 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7735 failed.
7736
7737 Example :
7738 external-check command /bin/true
7739
7740 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7741
7742
7743external-check path <path>
7744 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7746 yes | no | yes | yes
7747
7748 Arguments :
7749 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7750
7751 The default path is "".
7752
7753 Example :
7754 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7755
7756 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7757 "external-check command"
7758
7759
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007760persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007761persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007762 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7764 yes | no | yes | yes
7765 Arguments :
7766 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007767 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7768 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007769
7770 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7771 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007772 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007773 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7774 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7775 forwarded to this server.
7776
7777 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7778 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7779 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007780 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007781 a single "listen" section.
7782
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007783 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7784 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7785 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7786
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007787 Example :
7788 listen tse-farm
7789 bind :3389
7790 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7791 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7792 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7793 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7794 persist rdp-cookie
7795 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007796 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007797 balance rdp-cookie
7798 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7799 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7800
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007801 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7802 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007803
7804
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007805rate-limit sessions <rate>
7806 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | yes | yes | no
7809 Arguments :
7810 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7811 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7812
7813 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7814 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7815 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7816 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7817 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7818 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7819
7820 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7821 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7822 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7823 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7824
7825 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7826 listen smtp
7827 mode tcp
7828 bind :25
7829 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007830 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007831
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007832 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7833 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7834 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007835
7836 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7837
7838
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007839redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7840redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7841redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007842 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 no | yes | yes | yes
7845
7846 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007847 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007848
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007850 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007851 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7852 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7853 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007854
7855 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7856 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7857 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7858 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7859 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007860 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7861 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7862 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7863 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007864
7865 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7866 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7867 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7868 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7869 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7870 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007871 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007872 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007873 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7874 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7875 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007876
7877 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007878 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7879 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7880 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007881 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007882 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7883 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7884 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7885 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007886
7887 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007888 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007889
7890 - "drop-query"
7891 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7892 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7893 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7894 with a location-type redirect.
7895
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007896 - "append-slash"
7897 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7898 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7899 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7900 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7901
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007902 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7903 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7904 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7905 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7906 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7907 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7908 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7909
7910 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7911 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7912 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7913 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7914 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7915 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7916 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007917
7918 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7919 acl clear dst_port 80
7920 acl secure dst_port 8080
7921 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007922 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007923 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007924 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7925
7926 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007927 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7928 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7929 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007930 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007931
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007932 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7933 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7934 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7935
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007936 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007937 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007938
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007939 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007940 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7941 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7942 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007945
7946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007947redisp (deprecated)
7948redispatch (deprecated)
7949 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007952 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007953
7954 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7955 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7956 be able to access the service anymore.
7957
7958 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7959 redistribute them to a working server.
7960
7961 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7962 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7963 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007965 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7966 "option redispatch" instead.
7967
7968 See also : "option redispatch"
7969
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007970
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007971reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007972 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 no | yes | yes | yes
7975 Arguments :
7976 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7977 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007978 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007980 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7981 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7982
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7984 the last header of an HTTP request.
7985
7986 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7987 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7988 responses.
7989
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007990 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7991 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7992 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7993
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007994 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7995 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007996
7997
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007998reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7999reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008000 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 no | yes | yes | yes
8003 Arguments :
8004 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8005 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8006 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8007 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8008 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8009 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8010 ignores case.
8011
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008012 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8013 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8014
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008015 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8016 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8017 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8018 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008019 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008020
8021 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8022 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8023
8024 Example :
8025 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8026 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8027 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8028
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008029 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8030 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008031
8032
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008033reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8034reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008035 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8037 no | yes | yes | yes
8038 Arguments :
8039 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8040 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8041 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8042 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8043 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8044 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8045
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008046 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8047 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008049 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8050 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8051 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8052 next servers.
8053
8054 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8055 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8056 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8057
8058 Example :
8059 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8060 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8061 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8062
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008063 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8064 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008065
8066
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008067reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8068reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008069 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8071 no | yes | yes | yes
8072 Arguments :
8073 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8074 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8075 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8076 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8077 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8078 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8079 case.
8080
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008081 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8082 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8083
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008084 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8085 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8086 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8087 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008088 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008089
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008090 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008091 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008092 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008093
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008094 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8095 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8096
8097 Example :
8098 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8099 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8100 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8101
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008102 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8103 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008104
8105
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008106reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8107reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008108 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 no | yes | yes | yes
8111 Arguments :
8112 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8113 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8114 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8115 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8116 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8117 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8118 case.
8119
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008120 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8121 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8122
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008123 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8124 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8125 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8126 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8127
8128 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8129 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8130
8131 Example :
8132 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8133 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8134 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8135 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8136
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008137 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8138 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008139
8140
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008141reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8142reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008143 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 no | yes | yes | yes
8146 Arguments :
8147 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8148 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8149 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8150 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8151 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8152 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8153
8154 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8155 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8156 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8157 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008158 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008159
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008160 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8161 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8162
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008163 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8164 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8165 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8166
8167 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8168 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8169 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8170 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8171 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8172
8173 Example :
8174 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008175 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008176 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8177 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8178
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008179 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8180 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008181
8182
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008183reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8184reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008185 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 no | yes | yes | yes
8188 Arguments :
8189 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8190 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8191 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8192 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8193 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8194 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8195 ignores case.
8196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008197 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8198 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8199
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008200 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8201 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008202 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8203 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8204 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008205 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8206 not set.
8207
8208 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8209 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8210 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8211 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8212 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8213
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008214 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008215 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008216 # block all others.
8217 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8218 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8219
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008220 # block bad guys
8221 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8222 reqitarpit . if badguys
8223
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008224 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8225 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008226
8227
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008228retries <value>
8229 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8230 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8231 yes | no | yes | yes
8232 Arguments :
8233 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8234 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8235 default value is 3.
8236
8237 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8238 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8239 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8240
8241 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008242 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8243 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008244
8245 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8246 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8247
8248 See also : "option redispatch"
8249
8250
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008251retry-on [list of keywords]
8252 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 yes | no | yes | yes
8255 Arguments :
8256 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8257 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8258 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8259 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8260
8261 none never retry
8262
8263 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8264 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8265
8266 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8267 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8268 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8269 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8270 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8271 processing the request.
8272
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008273 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8274 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8275 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8276 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8277 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8278 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8279 overflow attack for example).
8280
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008281 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8282 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8283 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8284 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8285 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8286 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8287 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8288 amplify denial of service attacks.
8289
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008290 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8291 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8292 considered to be safe to retry.
8293
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008294 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8295 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8296 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8297 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8298
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008299 all-retryable-errors
8300 retry request for any error that are considered
8301 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8302 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8303 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8304
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008305 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8306 not cumulative.
8307
8308 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8309 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8310 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8311 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8312
8313 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8314 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8315 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8316 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8317 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8318 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8319 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8320 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8321 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8322 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8323 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8324 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8325
8326 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8327 should not use this directive.
8328
8329 The default is "conn-failure".
8330
8331 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8332
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008333rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008334 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 no | yes | yes | yes
8337 Arguments :
8338 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8339 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008340 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008341
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008342 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8343 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8344
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008345 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8346 the last header of an HTTP response.
8347
8348 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8349 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8350 responses.
8351
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008352 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8353 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008354
8355
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008356rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8357rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008358 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8360 no | yes | yes | yes
8361 Arguments :
8362 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8363 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8364 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8365 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8366 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8367 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8368 ignores case.
8369
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008370 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8371 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8372
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008373 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8374 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008375 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008376 client.
8377
8378 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8379 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8380 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8381
8382 Example :
8383 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008384 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008385
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008386 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8387 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008388
8389
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008390rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8391rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008392 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8394 no | yes | yes | yes
8395 Arguments :
8396 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8397 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8398 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8399 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8400 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8401 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8402 ignores case.
8403
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008404 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8405 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8406
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008407 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8408 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8409 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8410 case-sensitive.
8411
8412 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008413 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8414 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8415 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008416
8417 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8418 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8419
8420 Example :
8421 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8422 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8423
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008424 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8425 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008426
8427
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008428rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8429rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008430 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8432 no | yes | yes | yes
8433 Arguments :
8434 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8435 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8436 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8437 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8438 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8439 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8440 ignores case.
8441
8442 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8443 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8444 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8445 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008446 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008447
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008448 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8449 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8450
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008451 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8452 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8453 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8454
8455 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8456 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8457 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8458 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8459 are not case-sensitive.
8460
8461 Example :
8462 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8463 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8464
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008465 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8466 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008467
8468
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008469server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470 Declare a server in a backend
8471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 no | no | yes | yes
8473 Arguments :
8474 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008475 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008476 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008477
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008478 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8479 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8480 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8481 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008482 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8483 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8484 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8485 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8486 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008487 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8488 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8489 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8490 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8491 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8492 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8493 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008494 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008495 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8496 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8497 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8498 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8499 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8500 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008501 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8502 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008503 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8504 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008506 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008507 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8508 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8509 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8510 adding this value to the client's port.
8511
8512 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8513 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008514 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008515
8516 Examples :
8517 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8518 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008519 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008520 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8521 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8522 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008523
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008524 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8525 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8526 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8527 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8528 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8529
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008530 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8531 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008532
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008533server-state-file-name [<file>]
8534 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8535 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8536 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8537 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8538 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8539 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8540
8541 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8542 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8543
8544 global
8545 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8546
8547 backend bk
8548 load-server-state-from-file
8549
8550 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8551 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008552
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008553server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8554 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8555 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8557 no | no | yes | yes
8558
8559 Arguments:
8560 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8561
8562 <num | range>
8563 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8564 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8565 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8566 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8567
8568 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8569
8570 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8571
8572 <params*>
8573 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8574 keyword.
8575
8576 Examples:
8577 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8578 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8579 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8580
8581 # or
8582 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8583
8584 # would be equivalent to:
8585 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8586 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8587 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8588
8589
8590
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008592source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008593source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008594 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8596 yes | no | yes | yes
8597 Arguments :
8598 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8599 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008600
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008601 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008602 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8603 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8604 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8605 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8606 supported prefixes are :
8607 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8608 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8609 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008610 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008611 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8612 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008613
8614 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8615 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008616 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8617 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8618 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008619
8620 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8621 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8622 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8623 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8624 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8625 <addr>.
8626
8627 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8628 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8629 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8630 port.
8631
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008632 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8633 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8634 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8635 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008636 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008637 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8638 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8639 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8640 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8641 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8642 HTTP header.
8643
8644 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8645 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008646 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008647 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8648 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8649 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8650 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8651 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8652 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8653 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8654
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008655 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8656 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8657 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8658 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8659 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8660 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8661
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008662 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8663 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8664 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8665 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8666
8667 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8668 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8669 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8670 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8671 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8672 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8673
8674 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8675 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8676 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8677 there are two methods :
8678
8679 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8680 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8681 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8682 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8683 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8684 of the client ranges may be used.
8685
8686 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8687 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8688 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8689 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8690 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8691 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8692 same session.
8693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008694 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8695 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8696 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008697 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008698
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008699 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8700
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008701 Examples :
8702 backend private
8703 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8704 source 192.168.1.200
8705
8706 backend transparent_ssl1
8707 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8708 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8709
8710 backend transparent_ssl2
8711 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8712 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8713 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8714
8715 backend transparent_ssl3
8716 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8717 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8718 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8719
8720 backend transparent_smtp
8721 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8722 # with Tproxy version 4.
8723 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8724
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008725 backend transparent_http
8726 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8727 # proxy.
8728 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008730 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008731 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008733
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008734srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8735 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8737 yes | no | yes | yes
8738 Arguments :
8739 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8740 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8741 as explained at the top of this document.
8742
8743 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8744 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8745 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8746 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8747 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8748 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8749 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8750
8751 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8752 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8753 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8754 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8755 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008756 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008757 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008759
8760 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8761 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8762 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8763 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8764 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8765 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8766
8767 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8768 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8769
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008770 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8771 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008772
8773
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008774stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8775 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008777 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008778
8779 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8780 matched.
8781
8782 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8783 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8784
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008785 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8786 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008787 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008788
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008789 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8790 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8791 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8792 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008793
8794 Example :
8795 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8796 backend stats_localhost
8797 stats enable
8798 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8799
8800 Example :
8801 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8802 backend stats_auth
8803 stats enable
8804 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8805 stats admin if TRUE
8806
8807 Example :
8808 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8809 userlist stats-auth
8810 group admin users admin
8811 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8812 group readonly users haproxy
8813 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8814
8815 backend stats_auth
8816 stats enable
8817 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8818 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8819 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8820 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8821
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008822 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8823 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8824 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008825
8826
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008827stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8828 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008830 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008831 Arguments :
8832 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8833
8834 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8835
8836 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8837 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8838 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8839 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8840 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8841 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8842
8843 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8844 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8845 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008846 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008847
8848 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8849 report using "stats scope".
8850
8851 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8852 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8853 unobvious parameters.
8854
8855 Example :
8856 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8857 backend public_www
8858 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8859 stats enable
8860 stats hide-version
8861 stats scope .
8862 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008863 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008864 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8865 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8866
8867 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8868 backend private_monitoring
8869 stats enable
8870 stats uri /admin?stats
8871 stats refresh 5s
8872
8873 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8874
8875
8876stats enable
8877 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008879 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008880 Arguments : none
8881
8882 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8883 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8884 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8885 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8886 - stats auth : no authentication
8887 - stats scope : no restriction
8888
8889 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8890 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8891 unobvious parameters.
8892
8893 Example :
8894 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8895 backend public_www
8896 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8897 stats enable
8898 stats hide-version
8899 stats scope .
8900 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008901 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008902 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8903 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8904
8905 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8906 backend private_monitoring
8907 stats enable
8908 stats uri /admin?stats
8909 stats refresh 5s
8910
8911 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8912
8913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914stats hide-version
8915 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008917 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008918 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008920 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8921 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8922 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8923 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8924 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8925 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008927 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8928 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8929 unobvious parameters.
8930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931 Example :
8932 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8933 backend public_www
8934 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008935 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008936 stats hide-version
8937 stats scope .
8938 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008940 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8941 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008942
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008943 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8944 backend private_monitoring
8945 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008946 stats uri /admin?stats
8947 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008949 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008950
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008951
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008952stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8953 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8954 Access control for statistics
8955
8956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8957 no | no | yes | yes
8958
8959 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8960 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8961 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8962 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8963 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8964 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8965
8966 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8967 instance.
8968
8969 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8970 about ACL usage.
8971
8972
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008973stats realm <realm>
8974 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008977 Arguments :
8978 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8979 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8980 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8981
8982 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8983 using a backslash ('\').
8984
8985 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8986 only related to authentication.
8987
8988 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8989 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8990 unobvious parameters.
8991
8992 Example :
8993 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8994 backend public_www
8995 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8996 stats enable
8997 stats hide-version
8998 stats scope .
8999 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009000 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009001 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9002 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9003
9004 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9005 backend private_monitoring
9006 stats enable
9007 stats uri /admin?stats
9008 stats refresh 5s
9009
9010 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9011
9012
9013stats refresh <delay>
9014 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009016 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009017 Arguments :
9018 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9019 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9020 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9021 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9022 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9023 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9024
9025 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9026 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9027 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9028 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9029
9030 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9031 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9032 unobvious parameters.
9033
9034 Example :
9035 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9036 backend public_www
9037 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9038 stats enable
9039 stats hide-version
9040 stats scope .
9041 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009042 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009043 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9044 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9045
9046 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9047 backend private_monitoring
9048 stats enable
9049 stats uri /admin?stats
9050 stats refresh 5s
9051
9052 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9053
9054
9055stats scope { <name> | "." }
9056 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009058 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009059 Arguments :
9060 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9061 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9062 section in which the statement appears.
9063
9064 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9065 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9066 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9067 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9068 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9069 exists.
9070
9071 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9072 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9073 unobvious parameters.
9074
9075 Example :
9076 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9077 backend public_www
9078 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9079 stats enable
9080 stats hide-version
9081 stats scope .
9082 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009083 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009084 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9085 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9086
9087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9088 backend private_monitoring
9089 stats enable
9090 stats uri /admin?stats
9091 stats refresh 5s
9092
9093 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9094
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009095
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009096stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009097 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009101 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009102 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9103
9104 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9105 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9106
9107 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9108 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009110
9111 Example :
9112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9113 backend private_monitoring
9114 stats enable
9115 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9116 stats uri /admin?stats
9117 stats refresh 5s
9118
9119 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9120 global section.
9121
9122
9123stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009124 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9126 yes | yes | yes | yes
9127 Arguments : none
9128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009129 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009130 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9131 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9132 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9133 - IP (socket, server)
9134 - cookie (backend, server)
9135
9136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009138 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009139
9140 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9141
9142
9143stats show-node [ <name> ]
9144 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009146 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009147 Arguments:
9148 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9149 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9150
9151 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9152 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009153 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009154
9155 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9156 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9157 unobvious parameters.
9158
9159 Example:
9160 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9161 backend private_monitoring
9162 stats enable
9163 stats show-node Europe-1
9164 stats uri /admin?stats
9165 stats refresh 5s
9166
9167 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9168 section.
9169
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009170
9171stats uri <prefix>
9172 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009174 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009175 Arguments :
9176 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9177 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9178 query string.
9179
9180 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9181 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9182 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9183 possible to reach it in the application.
9184
9185 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009186 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009187 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9188 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9189 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9190 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9191
9192 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9193 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9194 an address or a port to statistics only.
9195
9196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9198 unobvious parameters.
9199
9200 Example :
9201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9202 backend public_www
9203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9204 stats enable
9205 stats hide-version
9206 stats scope .
9207 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009208 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9211
9212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9213 backend private_monitoring
9214 stats enable
9215 stats uri /admin?stats
9216 stats refresh 5s
9217
9218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9219
9220
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009221stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9222 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009224 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009225
9226 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009227 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009228 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009229 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009230 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9231
9232 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9233 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9234 the "stick-table" statement.
9235
9236 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9237 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9238 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9239 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9240 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9241
9242 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9243 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9244 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9245 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9246 transformation rules.
9247
9248 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9249 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9250 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9251 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9252 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9253 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9254 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9255
9256 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9257 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9258 ACL based conditions.
9259
9260 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9261 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9262 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9263 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9264
9265 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9266 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9267 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9268 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9269
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009270 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9271 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009272 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009273
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009274 Example :
9275 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9276 # last 30 minutes
9277 backend pop
9278 mode tcp
9279 balance roundrobin
9280 stick store-request src
9281 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9282 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9283 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9284
9285 backend smtp
9286 mode tcp
9287 balance roundrobin
9288 stick match src table pop
9289 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9290 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9291
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009292 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009293 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009294
9295
9296stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9297 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9299 no | no | yes | yes
9300
9301 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9302 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9303 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9304 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9305
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009306 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9307 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009309
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310 Examples :
9311 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009312 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009313
9314 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9315 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9316 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9317
9318
9319 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9320 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9321 backend http
9322 mode http
9323 balance roundrobin
9324 stick on src table https
9325 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9326 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9327 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9328
9329 backend https
9330 mode tcp
9331 balance roundrobin
9332 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9333 stick on src
9334 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9335 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9336
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009337 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009338
9339
9340stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9341 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 no | no | yes | yes
9344
9345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009346 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009347 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009348 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009349 server is selected.
9350
9351 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9352 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9353 the "stick-table" statement.
9354
9355 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9356 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9357 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9358 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9359 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9360 address.
9361
9362 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9363 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9364 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9365 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9366 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9367 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9368 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9369 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9370 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9371 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9372
9373 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9374 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9375 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9376 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9377 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9378 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9379 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9380
9381 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9382 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9383 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9384 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9385
9386 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9387 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9388 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9389 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9390 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9391 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009392 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9393 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9394 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9395 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9396 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9397 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009398
9399 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9400 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9401 the request.
9402
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009403 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9404 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009405 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009406
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009407 Example :
9408 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9409 # last 30 minutes
9410 backend pop
9411 mode tcp
9412 balance roundrobin
9413 stick store-request src
9414 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9415 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9416 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9417
9418 backend smtp
9419 mode tcp
9420 balance roundrobin
9421 stick match src table pop
9422 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9423 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9424
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009425 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009426 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009427
9428
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009429stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009430 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9431 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009432 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009434 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009435
9436 Arguments :
9437 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9438 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9439 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9440 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9441
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009442 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9443 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9444 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9445 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9446
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009447 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9448 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9449 instance.
9450
9451 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9452 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9453 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9454 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9455 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9456 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009457 to 32 characters.
9458
9459 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9460 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9461 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009462 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009463 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9464 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009465
9466 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009467 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9468 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9470 increase.
9471
9472 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009473 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9474 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9475 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009476
9477 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9478 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9479 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9480 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009481 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009482 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9483 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9484 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9485 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9486 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9487 parameter (see below).
9488
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009489 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9490 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9491 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9492 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9493 soft restart.
9494
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009495 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9496 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009497
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009498 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9499 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9500 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9501 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009502 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009503 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009504 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9505 if not expiration delay is specified.
9506
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009507 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9508 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9509 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9510 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009511 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9512 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9513 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9514 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9515 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9516 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9517 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9518 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9519 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9520 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9521 types and their arguments.
9522
9523 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9524 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9525 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9526 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9527
9528 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9529 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9530 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009531 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009532
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009533 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9534 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9535 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009536 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009537 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009538 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009539
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009540 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9541 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9542 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9543 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9544
9545 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9546 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9547 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9548 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9549 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9550 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9551
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009552 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9553 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9554 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9555 they were received.
9556
9557 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9558 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9559 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9560 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9561 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9562
9563 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9564 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9565 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9566 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9567 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9568
9569 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9570 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9571 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9572
9573 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9574 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9575 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9576 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9577 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9578
9579 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9580 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9581 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9582 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9583 the client side.
9584
9585 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9586 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9587 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9588 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9589 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9590 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9591 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9592
9593 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9594 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9595 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9596 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9597 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9598 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009599 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009600
9601 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9602 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9603 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9604 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9605 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9606 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9607
9608 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009609 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009610 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9611 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9612
9613 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9614 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9615 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9616 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9617 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9618 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9619 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9620 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9621 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9622 recommended for better fairness.
9623
9624 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009626 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9627 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9628
9629 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9630 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9631 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9632 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9633 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9634 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9635 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9636 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9637 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9638 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009639
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009640 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9641 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009642 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9643 reference it.
9644
9645 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9646 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009647 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9648 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9649 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009650
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009651 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9652 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9653 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9654 something that can be ignored.
9655
9656 Example:
9657 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9658 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9659 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9660 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9661
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009662 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009663 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009664
9665
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009666stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009667 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9669 no | no | yes | yes
9670
9671 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009672 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009673 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009674 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009675 server is selected.
9676
9677 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9678 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9679 the "stick-table" statement.
9680
9681 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9682 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9683 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9684 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9685
9686 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9687 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9688 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9689 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9690 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9691 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009692 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009693 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9694 rules.
9695
9696 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9697 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9698 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9699 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9700 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9701 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9702 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9703
9704 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9705 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9706 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9707 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9708
9709 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9710 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9711 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9712 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9713 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9714 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009715 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9716 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9717 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9718 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9719 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9720 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9721 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9722 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9723 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009724
9725 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9726
9727 Example :
9728 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9729 backend https
9730 mode tcp
9731 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009732 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009733 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009734
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009735 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9736 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9737
9738 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9739 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9740 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9741
9742 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9743 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009744
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009745 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9746 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9747 # at offset 44.
9748
9749 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9750 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9751
9752 # Learn on response if server hello.
9753 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009754
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009755 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9756 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9757
9758 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9759 extraction.
9760
9761
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009762tcp-check connect [params*]
9763 Opens a new connection
9764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9765 no | no | yes | yes
9766
9767 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9768 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9769 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9770
9771 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9772 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9773 of the sequence.
9774
9775 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9776 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9777 do.
9778
9779 Parameters :
9780 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9781 use the TCP connection.
9782
9783 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9784 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9785 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9786
9787 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9788
9789 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9790
9791 Examples:
9792 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9793 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9794 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9795 option tcp-check
9796 tcp-check connect
9797 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9798 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9799 tcp-check send \r\n
9800 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9801 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9802 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9803 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9804 tcp-check send \r\n
9805 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9806 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9807
9808 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9809 option tcp-check
9810 tcp-check connect port 110
9811 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9812 tcp-check connect port 143
9813 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9814 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9815
9816 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9817
9818
9819tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009820 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009821 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9822 no | no | yes | yes
9823
9824 Arguments :
9825 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9826 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9827 binary.
9828 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9829 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9830 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9831
9832 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9833 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9834 with the usual backslash ('\').
9835 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009836 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009837 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9838 used upper or lower case.
9839
9840
9841 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9842
9843 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9844 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9845 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9846 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9847 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9848 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9849 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9850 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9851
9852 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9853 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9854 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9855 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9856 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9857 expression.
9858
9859 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9860 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9861 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9862 this exact hexadecimal string.
9863 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9864
9865 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9866 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9867 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9868 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9869 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9870 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9871 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9872 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9873 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9874 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9875 the null character.
9876
9877 Examples :
9878 # perform a POP check
9879 option tcp-check
9880 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9881
9882 # perform an IMAP check
9883 option tcp-check
9884 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9885
9886 # look for the redis master server
9887 option tcp-check
9888 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009889 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009890 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9891 tcp-check expect string role:master
9892 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9893 tcp-check expect string +OK
9894
9895
9896 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9897 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9898
9899
9900tcp-check send <data>
9901 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9902 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9903 no | no | yes | yes
9904
9905 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9906 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9907
9908 Examples :
9909 # look for the redis master server
9910 option tcp-check
9911 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9912 tcp-check expect string role:master
9913
9914 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9915 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9916
9917
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009918tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9919 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009920 tcp health check
9921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9922 no | no | yes | yes
9923
9924 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9925 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009926 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009927 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9928 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9929 hexadecimal string.
9930 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9931
9932 Examples :
9933 # redis check in binary
9934 option tcp-check
9935 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9936 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9937
9938
9939 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9940 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9941
9942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009943tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9944 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9946 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009947 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009948 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9949 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009950
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009951 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009952
9953 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9954 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009955 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9956 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9957 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9958 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9959 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9960 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009962 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9963 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9964 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9965 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009966
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009967 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009968 - accept :
9969 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9970 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9971 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009973 - reject :
9974 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9975 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9976 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9977 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9978 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9979 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9980 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9981 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9982 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9983 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9984 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009985 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009986
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009987 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9988 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9989 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9990 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9991 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9992 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9993 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9994 hosts.
9995
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009996 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9997 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9998 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9999 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10000 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10001 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10002 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10003 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10004
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010005 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10006 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10007 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10008 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10009 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10010 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10011 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10012 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10013 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010014 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10015 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010016
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010017 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010018 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010019 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10020 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10021 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010022 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010023 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10024 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10025 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10026 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10027 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10028 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10029 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10030 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010032 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010033 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010035 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010036 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10037 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10038 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010040 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10041 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10042 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10043 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010045 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10046 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10047 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10048 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10049 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010050 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10051 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10052 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10053 layer7 information is extracted.
10054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010055 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10056 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10057 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10058 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10059 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010060
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010061 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10062 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10063 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10064 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10065
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010066 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10067 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10068 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10069 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10070
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010071 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10072 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10073 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10074 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10075 continues.
10076
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010077 - set-src <expr> :
10078 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10079 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10080 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010081 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010083 Arguments:
10084 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10085 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010086
10087 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010088 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10089
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010090 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10091 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010092
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010093 - set-src-port <expr> :
10094 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10095 expression.
10096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010097 Arguments:
10098 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10099 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010100
10101 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010102 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10103
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010104 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10105 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10106 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010107
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010108 - set-dst <expr> :
10109 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10110 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10111 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10112 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10113 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10114
10115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10116 followed by some converters.
10117
10118 Example:
10119
10120 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10121 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10122
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010123 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10124 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10125
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010126 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10127 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10128 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10129 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10130
10131
10132 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10133 followed by some converters.
10134
10135 Example:
10136
10137 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10138
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010139 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10140 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10141 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10142
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010143 - "silent-drop" :
10144 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010145 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010146 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10147 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10148 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10149 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10150 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10152 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010153 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10154 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010155 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010156 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10157 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10158 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10159 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010161 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10162 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10163 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010165 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10166 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10167 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010169 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010170 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010171 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010172
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010173 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10174 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10175 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010177 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010178 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10179 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010180
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010181 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10182
10183 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10184
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010185 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10186
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010187 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010188
10189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010190tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10191 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010193 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010194 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010195 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10196 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010198 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010199
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010200 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010201 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10202 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10203 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10204 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010206 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10207 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10208 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10209 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010210 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10211 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10212 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10213 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10214 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10215 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010216 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010217 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010219 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10220 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10221 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10222 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010223
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010224 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010225 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010226 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010227 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10228 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010229 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010230 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010231 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010232 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010233 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010234 - set-dst <expr>
10235 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010236 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010237 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010238 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010239 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010240 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010242 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10243 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010244 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10245 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010246
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010247 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10248 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10249 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10250 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10251 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10252 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010254 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010255 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10256 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010258 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010259 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10260 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10261 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10262 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010263 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10264 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10265 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010266
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010267 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010268 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10269 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10270 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010271
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010272 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10273 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10274
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010275 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010276 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10277 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010278
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010279 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10280 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010281 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010282 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10283 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010284 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010285 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010286 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010287 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10288 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010289 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010290 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10291 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010292
10293 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10294 followed by some converters.
10295
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010296 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10297 <var-name>.
10298
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010299 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10300 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10301 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10302 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10303 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10304
10305 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10306 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10307 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10308 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10309 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10310 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10311 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10312 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10313 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10314 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10315 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10316
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010317 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10318 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10319 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10320 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10321 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10322
10323 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10324
10325 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10326
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010327 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10328 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10329 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10330 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10331 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10332 evaluated.
10333
10334 Example:
10335 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10336
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010337 Example:
10338
10339 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010340 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010341
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010343 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10344 # and reject everything else.
10345 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10346 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010347 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010348 tcp-request content reject
10349
10350 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010351 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10352 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10353 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010354 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010355
10356 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10357 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10358 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010359 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010360 tcp-request content reject
10361
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010362 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010363 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010364 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010365 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010366 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10367 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010368
10369 Example:
10370 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10371 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010372 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010373
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010375 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010376
10377 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010378 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010379 # protecting all our sites
10380 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010381 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10382 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010383 ...
10384 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10385
10386 backend http_dynamic
10387 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010388 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010389 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010390 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010391 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010392 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010393 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010395 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010396
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010397 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10398 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010399
10400
10401tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10402 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010404 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010405 Arguments :
10406 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10407 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10408 as explained at the top of this document.
10409
10410 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10411 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10412 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10413 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10414 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10415
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010416 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10417 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10418 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10419 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10420
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010421 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10422 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010423 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010424 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010425 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10426 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10427 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10428 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010429
10430 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10431 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10432 it pass through unaffected.
10433
10434 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10435 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10436 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010437 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010438 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10439 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010440 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10441 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10442 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010443
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010444 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010445 "timeout client".
10446
10447
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010448tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10449 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10451 no | no | yes | yes
10452 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010453 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10454 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010455
10456 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10457
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010458 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010459 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10460 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010461 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10462 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010463
10464 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10465
10466 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10467 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10468 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10469 inserted.
10470
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010471 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010472 - accept :
10473 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10474 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10475 the rules evaluation.
10476
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010477 - close :
10478 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10479 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10480 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10481 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10482 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10483 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010484 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010485 protocols.
10486
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010487 - reject :
10488 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10489 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010490 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010491
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010492 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10493 Sets a variable.
10494
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010495 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10496 Unsets a variable.
10497
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010498 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10499 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10500 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10501 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10502
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010503 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10504 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10505 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10506 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10507
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010508 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10509 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10510 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10511 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10512 continues.
10513
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010514 - "silent-drop" :
10515 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010516 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010517 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10518 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10519 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10520 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10521 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010522 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10523 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010524 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10525 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010526 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010527 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10528 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10529 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10530 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10531
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010532 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10533 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10534
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010535 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10536 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10537 for changing the default action to a reject.
10538
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010539 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10540 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10541 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10542 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010543 period.
10544
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010545 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10546 declared inline.
10547
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010548 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10549 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010550 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010551 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10552 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010553 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010554 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010555 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010556 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10557 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010558 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010559 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10560 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010561
10562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10563 followed by some converters.
10564
10565 Example:
10566
10567 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10568
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010569 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10570 <var-name>.
10571
10572 Example:
10573
10574 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10575
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010576 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10577 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10578 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10579 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10580 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10581
10582 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10583
10584 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10585
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10587
10588 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10589
10590
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010591tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10592 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10594 no | yes | yes | no
10595 Arguments :
10596 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10597 below.
10598
10599 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10600
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010601 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010602 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10603 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10604 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10605 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10606 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10607 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10608 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010609 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010610 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10611 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10612 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10613 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10614 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10615 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10616 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10617 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10618 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10619 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10620 instead.
10621
10622 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10623 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10624 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10625 rules which may be inserted.
10626
10627 Several types of actions are supported :
10628 - accept : the request is accepted
10629 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10630 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10631 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010632 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010633 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10634 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010635 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010636 - silent-drop
10637
10638 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10639 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10640 sections for a complete description.
10641
10642 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10643 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10644 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10645
10646 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10647 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10648 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10649 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10650 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10651
10652 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10653 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10654
10655 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10656 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10657 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10658
10659 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10660 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10661 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10662
10663 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10664 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10665 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10666
10667 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10668 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10669 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10670
10671 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10672
10673 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10674
10675
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010676tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10677 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10679 no | no | yes | yes
10680 Arguments :
10681 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10682 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10683 as explained at the top of this document.
10684
10685 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10686
10687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010688timeout check <timeout>
10689 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10690 established.
10691
10692 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10693 yes | no | yes | yes
10694 Arguments:
10695 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10696 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10697 as explained at the top of this document.
10698
10699 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10700 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010701 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010702 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010703 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10704 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10705 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010706
10707 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10708 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10709
10710 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10711 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010712 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010713
10714 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10715 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10716 forget about it.
10717
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010718 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10719 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010720
10721
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010722timeout client <timeout>
10723timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10724 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10726 yes | yes | yes | no
10727 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10730 as explained at the top of this document.
10731
10732 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10733 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10734 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010735 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10736 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10737 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10738 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010739 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10740 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10741 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010742 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010743 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10745 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010746 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10747 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010748
10749 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10750 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10751 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10752 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010753 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010754 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10755
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010756 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010758 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10759 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10760 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10761
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010762 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10763 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010764
10765
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010766timeout client-fin <timeout>
10767 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10769 yes | yes | yes | no
10770 Arguments :
10771 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10772 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10773 as explained at the top of this document.
10774
10775 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10776 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10777 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10778 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10779 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10780 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10781 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010782 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10783 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10784 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010785
10786 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10787 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10788 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10789
10790 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10791
10792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010793timeout connect <timeout>
10794timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10795 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10797 yes | no | yes | yes
10798 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10801 as explained at the top of this document.
10802
10803 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010804 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010805 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010807 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10808 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809
10810 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10811 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10812 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10813 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010814 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010815 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10816
10817 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10818 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10819 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10820
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010821 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10822 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010823
10824
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010825timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10826 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10828 yes | yes | yes | yes
10829 Arguments :
10830 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10831 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10832 as explained at the top of this document.
10833
10834 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10835 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10836 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10837 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10838 once the request has started to present itself.
10839
10840 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10841 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10842 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10843 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10844 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10845
10846 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10847 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10848 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10849 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10850
10851 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10852 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010853 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010854 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10855 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010856 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010857
10858 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10859 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10860 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10861 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10862
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010863 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10864 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010865 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10866
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010867 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10868
10869
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010870timeout http-request <timeout>
10871 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010873 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010874 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010875 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010876 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10877 as explained at the top of this document.
10878
10879 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10880 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10881 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10882 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10883 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10884 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10885 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010886 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10887 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10888 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10889 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010890 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010891 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10892 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010893
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010894 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10895 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10896 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10897 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10898 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010899 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010900
10901 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10902 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010903 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010904 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10905 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10906
10907 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010908 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10909 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10910 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010911
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010912 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010913 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010914
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010915
10916timeout queue <timeout>
10917 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10919 yes | no | yes | yes
10920 Arguments :
10921 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10922 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10923 as explained at the top of this document.
10924
10925 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10926 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10927 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10928 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10929 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10930
10931 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10932 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10933 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10934 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10935
10936 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10937
10938
10939timeout server <timeout>
10940timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10941 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10943 yes | no | yes | yes
10944 Arguments :
10945 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10946 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10947 as explained at the top of this document.
10948
10949 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10950 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10951 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10952 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10953 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10954 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10955 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10956
10957 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10958 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10959 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10960 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10961 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010962 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010963 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010964 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10965 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010966 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10967 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010968
10969 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10970 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10971 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10972 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010973 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010974 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10975
10976 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10977 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10978 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10979
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010980 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010981
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010982
10983timeout server-fin <timeout>
10984 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10986 yes | no | yes | yes
10987 Arguments :
10988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10990 as explained at the top of this document.
10991
10992 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10993 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10994 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10995 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10996 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10997 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10998 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10999 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11000 situations, it should not be needed.
11001
11002 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11003 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11004 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11005
11006 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11007
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011008
11009timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011010 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11012 yes | yes | yes | yes
11013 Arguments :
11014 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11016 as explained at the top of this document.
11017
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011018 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11019 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11020 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11021 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011022
11023 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11024 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11025 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11026 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011027 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011028
11029 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11030
11031
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011032timeout tunnel <timeout>
11033 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11035 yes | no | yes | yes
11036 Arguments :
11037 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11038 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11039 as explained at the top of this document.
11040
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011041 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011042 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11043 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11044 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011045 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11046 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011047 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11048 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11049 specified.
11050
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011051 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11052 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11053 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11054 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11055 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11056 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11057 state.
11058
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011059 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11060 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11061 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11062 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011064
11065 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11066 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11067 forget about it.
11068
11069 Example :
11070 defaults http
11071 option http-server-close
11072 timeout connect 5s
11073 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011074 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011075 timeout server 30s
11076 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11077
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011078 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011079
11080
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011081transparent (deprecated)
11082 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011084 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011085 Arguments : none
11086
11087 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11088 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11089 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11090 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11091 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11092 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11093 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11094 appropriate server.
11095
11096 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11097
11098 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11099 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11100
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011101 See also: "option transparent"
11102
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011103unique-id-format <string>
11104 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11106 yes | yes | yes | no
11107 Arguments :
11108 <string> is a log-format string.
11109
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011110 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11111 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11112 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11113 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011115 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11116 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11117 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11118 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11119 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11120 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11121 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11122 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011123
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011124 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11125 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011127 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011128
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011129 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011130
11131 will generate:
11132
11133 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11134
11135 See also: "unique-id-header"
11136
11137unique-id-header <name>
11138 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11140 yes | yes | yes | no
11141 Arguments :
11142 <name> is the name of the header.
11143
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011144 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11145 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011146
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011147 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011148
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011149 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011150 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11151
11152 will generate:
11153
11154 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11155
11156 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011157
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011158use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011159 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11161 no | yes | yes | no
11162 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011163 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11164 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011165
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011166 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11167 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011168
11169 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11170 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11171 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011172 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011174 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11175 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011176
11177 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11178 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11179 assign the backend.
11180
11181 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11182 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11183 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11184 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11185 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11186 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11187
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011188 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011189 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011190 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11191 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11192 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11193
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011194 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11195 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11196 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11197 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11198 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11199 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11200 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11201 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11202 cannot be forced from the request.
11203
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011204 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011205 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11206 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11207
11208 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11209 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011210
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011211
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011212use-server <server> if <condition>
11213use-server <server> unless <condition>
11214 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11216 no | no | yes | yes
11217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011218 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011219
11220 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11221
11222 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11223 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11224 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11225
11226 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11227 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11228 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11229 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11230 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11231 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11232 matches will assign the server.
11233
11234 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11235 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11236 with the next rules until one matches.
11237
11238 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11239 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11240 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11241 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11242
11243 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11244 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11245 stripped.
11246
11247 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11248 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11249 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11250 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11251
11252 Example :
11253 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11254 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11255 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11256 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11257 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11258 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011259 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011260 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11261 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11262
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011263 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100112665. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011267--------------------------
11268
11269The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11270depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11271settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11272written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11273described in this section.
11274
11275
112765.1. Bind options
11277-----------------
11278
11279The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11280as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11281no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11282parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11283while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11284provided immediately after the setting name.
11285
11286The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11287
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011288accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11289 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11290 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11291 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11292 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11293 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11294 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11295 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11296 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11297 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011298 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11299 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11300 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011301
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011302accept-proxy
11303 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011304 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11305 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11307 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11308 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11309 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011310 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011311 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11312 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011313 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11314 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011316allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011317 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011318 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011319 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011320 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11321 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011322
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011323alpn <protocols>
11324 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11325 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11326 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011327 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011328 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011329 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11330 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11331 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11332 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11333 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11334 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11335 preference, like below :
11336
11337 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011338
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011339backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011340 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011341 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11342
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011343curves <curves>
11344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11345 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11346 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11347 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11348 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11349 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11350
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011351ecdhe <named curve>
11352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011353 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11354 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011355
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011356ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11358 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11359 client's certificate.
11360
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011361ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11363 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11364 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11365 error is ignored.
11366
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011367ca-sign-file <cafile>
11368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11369 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11370 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11371 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11372 'generate-certificates' for details.
11373
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011374ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011375 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11376 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11377 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11378 'generate-certificates' for details.
11379
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011380ciphers <ciphers>
11381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11382 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011383 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011384 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011385 information and recommendations see e.g.
11386 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11387 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11388 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11389
11390ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11392 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11393 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11394 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011395 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11396 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011397
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011398crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11400 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11401 to verify client's certificate.
11402
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011403crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011404 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11405 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11406 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11407 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11408 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11409 file.
11410
11411 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11412 are loaded.
11413
11414 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011415 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011416 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11417 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11418 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11419 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011420 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11421 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011422 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011423
11424 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11425 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11426 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11427 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011428 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11429 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011430
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011431 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011434 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11436 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011437 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11438 clients).
11439
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011440 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11441 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11442 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11443 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11444 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11445 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11446 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11447 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11448 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11449 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11450 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11451 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11452 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11453
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011454 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11455 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11456 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11457 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11458 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11459
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011460 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11461 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11462 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11463 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011464
11465 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11466 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11467 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11468 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11469 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11470 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11471 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11472 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11473 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11474
11475 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11476
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011477 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011478 a cert bundle.
11479
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011480 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011481 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11482 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11483 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11484 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11485 provide multi-cert support.
11486
11487 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11488
11489 Filename | CN | SAN
11490 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11491 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011492 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011493 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11494 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11495
11496 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11497 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11498 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11499 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011500 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11501 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11502 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011503
11504 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11505 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11506
11507 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11508 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11509 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11510
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011511crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011513 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011514 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011515 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011516
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011517crt-list <file>
11518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011519 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11520 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011521
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011522 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11523
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011524 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11525 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011526 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011527 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011528
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011529 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11530 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11531 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11532 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11533 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11534 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11535 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11536 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011537
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011538 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011539 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011540 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11541 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11542 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011543
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011544 crt-list file example:
11545 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011546 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011547 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011548 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011550defer-accept
11551 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11552 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11553 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011554 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011555 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11556 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11557 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11558 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11559 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11560 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11561 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11562
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011563expose-fd listeners
11564 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11565 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011566 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11567 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011568 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011569
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011570force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011571 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011572 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011573 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011574 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011575
11576force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011577 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011578 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011579 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011580
11581force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011582 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011583 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011584 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011585
11586force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011587 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011588 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011589 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011590
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011591force-tlsv13
11592 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11593 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011594 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011595
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011596generate-certificates
11597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11598 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11599 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11600 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11601 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11602 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11603 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11604 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11605 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11606 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11607 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11608
11609 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11610 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011612 certificate is used many times.
11613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011614gid <gid>
11615 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11616 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11617 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11618 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11619 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11620
11621group <group>
11622 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11623 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11624 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11625 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11626 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11627
11628id <id>
11629 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11630 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11631 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11632 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11633
11634interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011635 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11636 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11637 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11638 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11639 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11640 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011641 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11642 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11643 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11644 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11645 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11646 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011647
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011648level <level>
11649 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11650 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11651 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011652 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011653 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11654 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11655 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011656 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011657 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011658 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011659 all counters).
11660
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011661severity-output <format>
11662 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11663 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11664 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11665 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11666 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11667 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11668 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11669 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11670 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11671 rfc5424 convention.
11672
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011673maxconn <maxconn>
11674 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11675 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11676 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11677 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11678 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11679 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11680 eat all memory.
11681
11682mode <mode>
11683 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11684 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11685 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11686 UNIX sockets.
11687
11688mss <maxseg>
11689 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11690 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11691 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11692 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11693 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11694 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11695 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11696 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11697 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11698 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11699 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11700
11701name <name>
11702 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11703 page.
11704
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011705namespace <name>
11706 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11707 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11708 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11709 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11710
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011711nice <nice>
11712 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11713 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11714 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11715 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11716 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11717 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11718 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11719 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11720 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11721 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11722 one for an RDP socket.
11723
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011724no-ca-names
11725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11726 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11727
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011728no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011730 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011731 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011732 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011733 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11734 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011735
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011736no-tls-tickets
11737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11738 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11739 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011740 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11741 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011742
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011743no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011744 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011745 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011746 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011747 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011748 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11749 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011750
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011751no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011753 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011754 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011755 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011756 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11757 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011758
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011759no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011761 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011762 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011763 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011764 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11765 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011766
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011767no-tlsv13
11768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11769 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11770 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11771 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011772 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11773 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011774
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011775npn <protocols>
11776 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11777 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11778 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011779 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011780 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011781 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11782 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11783 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11784 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11785 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011786
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011787prefer-client-ciphers
11788 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11789 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11790 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011791 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11792 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11793 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011794
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011795process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011796 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011797 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011799 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11800 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11801 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11802 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011803 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011804 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11805 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11806 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11807 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11808 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011809
11810 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11811
11812 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11813 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11814 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11815 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11816 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11817 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11818 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11819 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011820
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011821proto <name>
11822 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11823 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11824 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11825 in haproxy -vv.
11826 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11827 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011828 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011829 h2" on the bind line.
11830
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011831ssl
11832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011833 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011834 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11835 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011836 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11837 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011839ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11840 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11841 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11842 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11843
11844ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11845 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11846 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11847 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11848
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011849strict-sni
11850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11851 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11852 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11853 See the "crt" option for more information.
11854
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011855tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011856 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011857 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11858 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011859 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011860 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11861 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11862 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11863 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11864 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11865 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11866 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11867
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011868tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011869 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011870 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11871 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11872 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11873 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11874 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11875 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11876 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011877 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11878 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11879 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011880
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011881tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11882 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011883 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11884 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11885 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11886 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11887 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11888 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11889 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11890 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11891 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11892 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011893 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11894 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011896transparent
11897 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11898 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11899 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11900 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11901 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11902 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11903 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11904 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11905 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11906 so check for support with your vendor.
11907
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011908v4v6
11909 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11910 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11911 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11912 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011913 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011914
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011915v6only
11916 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11917 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11918 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011919 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11920 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011921
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011922uid <uid>
11923 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11924 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11925 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11926 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11927 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11928
11929user <user>
11930 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11931 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11932 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11933 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11934 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11935
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011936verify [none|optional|required]
11937 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11938 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11939 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11940 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11941 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011942 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11943 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11944 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11945 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011946
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119475.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011948------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011950The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11951which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11952arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11953settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11954after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11955Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11956address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011958 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011959 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011960
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011961Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11962keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011964The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011965
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011966addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011967 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011968 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11969 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11970 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11971 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11972 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011973
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011974agent-check
11975 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011976 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011977 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11978 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11979 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011980
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011981 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011982 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011983 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11984 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11985 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011986
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011987 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11988 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11989 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11990 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11991 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011992
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011993 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011994 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011995
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011996 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11997 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11998 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011999
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012000 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12001 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12002 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012003
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012004 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12005 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12006 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12007 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12008 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012009 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012010 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012011
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012012 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12013 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012014
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012015 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12016 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12017 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12018 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12019 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12020 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12021 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12022 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12023 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012024
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012025 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12026 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012027 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12028 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12029 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012030 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012031
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012032 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012033 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012034
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012035agent-send <string>
12036 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12037 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12038 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12039 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12040 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12041
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012042agent-inter <delay>
12043 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12044 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12045
12046 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12047 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12048 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12049 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12050 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12051 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12052 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12053 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12054 of backends use the same servers.
12055
12056 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12057
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012058agent-addr <addr>
12059 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12060
12061 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12062 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12063 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12064 hostname, it will be resolved.
12065
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012066agent-port <port>
12067 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12068
12069 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12070
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012071allow-0rtt
12072 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012073 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12074 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012075
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012076alpn <protocols>
12077 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12078 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12079 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012080 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012081 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12082 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12083 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12084 now obsolete NPN extension.
12085 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12086 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12087
12088 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012090backup
12091 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12092 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12093 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12094 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012095 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12096 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012097
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012098ca-file <cafile>
12099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12100 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12101 server's certificate.
12102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012103check
12104 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012105 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12106 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12107 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12108 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12109 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12110 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12111 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012112 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12113 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012114 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12115 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012116
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012117check-send-proxy
12118 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12119 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12120 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12121 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12122 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12123 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12124 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12125
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012126check-alpn <protocols>
12127 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12128 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12129 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12130
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012131check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012132 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012133 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12134 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012135
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012136check-ssl
12137 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12138 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12139 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12140 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012141 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012142 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12143 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012144 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012145 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12146 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012147
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012148check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012149 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012150 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12151 for normal traffic.
12152
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012153ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12155 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12156 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012157 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12158 information and recommendations see e.g.
12159 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12160 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12161 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012162
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012163ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12165 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12166 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12167 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012168 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12169 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12170 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012172cookie <value>
12173 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12174 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12175 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12176 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12177 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12178 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12179 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12180
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012181crl-file <crlfile>
12182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12183 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12184 to verify server's certificate.
12185
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012186crt <cert>
12187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12188 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12189 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12190 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12191 certificate request.
12192
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012193disabled
12194 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12195 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12196 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12197 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12198 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012199 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012200
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012201enabled
12202 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12203 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12204 default value.
12205 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12206 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012208error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012209 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12210 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12211 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012213 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012215fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012216 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12217 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12218 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12219
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012220force-sslv3
12221 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12222 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012223 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012224 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012225
12226force-tlsv10
12227 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012228 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012229 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012230
12231force-tlsv11
12232 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012233 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012234 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012235
12236force-tlsv12
12237 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012238 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012239 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012240
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012241force-tlsv13
12242 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12243 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012244 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012246id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012247 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12248 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12249 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012250
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012251init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12252 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12253 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012254 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012255 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12256 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12257 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12258 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12259 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12260 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12261 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12262 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12263 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012264 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012265 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12266 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12267 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12268 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12269 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12270 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012271 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012272
12273 Example:
12274 defaults
12275 # never fail on address resolution
12276 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012278inter <delay>
12279fastinter <delay>
12280downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012281 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12282 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12283 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12284 between checks depending on the server state :
12285
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012286 Server state | Interval used
12287 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12288 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12289 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12290 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12291 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12292 or yet unchecked. |
12293 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12294 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12295 | "inter" otherwise.
12296 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012298 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12299 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12300 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12301 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012302 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12303 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12304 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12305 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12306 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012308maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012309 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12310 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012311 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12312 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12314 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12315 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12316 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12317
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012318 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12319 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12320 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12321 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12322 than 50 concurrent requests.
12323
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012324maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012325 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12326 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12327 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12328 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12329 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12330 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12331 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12332
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012333max-reuse <count>
12334 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12335 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12336 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12337 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12338 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12339 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12340 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12341 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012343minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012344 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12345 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12346 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12347 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12348 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12349 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012350 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012351 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012352
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012353namespace <name>
12354 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12355 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12356 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12357 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12358
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012359no-agent-check
12360 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12361 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12362 default value.
12363 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12364 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12365
12366no-backup
12367 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12368 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12369 default value.
12370 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12371 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12372
12373no-check
12374 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12375 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12376 default value.
12377 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12378 "default-server" "check" setting.
12379
12380no-check-ssl
12381 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12382 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12383 default value.
12384 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12385 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12386
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012387no-send-proxy
12388 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12389 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12390 default value.
12391 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12392 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12393
12394no-send-proxy-v2
12395 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12396 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12397 default value.
12398 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12399 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12400
12401no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12402 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12403 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12404 default value.
12405 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12406 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12407
12408no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12409 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12410 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12411 default value.
12412 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12413 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12414
12415no-ssl
12416 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12417 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12418 default value.
12419 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12420 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12421
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012422no-ssl-reuse
12423 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12424 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12425 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12426 and for paranoid users.
12427
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012428no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012429 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12430 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012431 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012432
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012433 Supported in default-server: No
12434
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012435no-tls-tickets
12436 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12437 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12438 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012439 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12440 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012441 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012442
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012443no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012444 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012445 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12446 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012447 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12448 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012449 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012450
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012451 Supported in default-server: No
12452
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012453no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012454 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012455 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12456 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012457 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12458 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012459 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012460
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012461 Supported in default-server: No
12462
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012463no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012464 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012465 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12466 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012467 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12468 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012469 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012470
12471 Supported in default-server: No
12472
12473no-tlsv13
12474 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12475 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12476 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12477 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12478 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012479 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012480
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012481 Supported in default-server: No
12482
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012483no-verifyhost
12484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12486 default value.
12487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12488 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012489
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012490no-tfo
12491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12493 default value.
12494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12495 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12496
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012497non-stick
12498 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12499 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12500 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12501
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012502npn <protocols>
12503 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12504 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12505 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012506 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012507 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12508 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12509 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012511observe <mode>
12512 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12513 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12514 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12515 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12516 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12517 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012518 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012519
12520 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012522on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012523 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12524 Currently, four modes are available:
12525 - fastinter: force fastinter
12526 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12527 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12528 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12529 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12530
12531 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12532
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012533on-marked-down <action>
12534 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12535 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012536 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12537 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12538 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12539 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12540 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12541 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12542 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12543 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012544
12545 Actions are disabled by default
12546
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012547on-marked-up <action>
12548 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12549 Currently one action is available:
12550 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12551 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12552 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12553 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012554 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12555 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012556 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12557 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12558
12559 Actions are disabled by default
12560
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012561pool-max-conn <max>
12562 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12563 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12564 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12565 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12566 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12567 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12568
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012569pool-purge-delay <delay>
12570 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012571 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012572 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012574port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012575 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12576 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12577 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12578 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12579 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12580 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12581
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012582proto <name>
12583
12584 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12585 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12586 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12587 reported in haproxy -vv.
12588 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12589 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012591redir <prefix>
12592 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12593 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12594 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12595 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12596 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12597 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12598 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12599 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012600 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012601 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012602 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12603 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12604 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12605 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12606
12607 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012609rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012610 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12611 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12612 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12613
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012614resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12615 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12616 server.
12617
12618 Available options:
12619
12620 * allow-dup-ip
12621 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12622 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12623 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12624 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12625 For such case, simply enable this option.
12626 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12627
12628 * prevent-dup-ip
12629 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12630 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12631 same fqdn.
12632 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12633
12634 Example:
12635 backend b_myapp
12636 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12637 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12638 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12639
12640 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12641 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12642 it
12643 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12644 different address
12645
12646 Default value: not set
12647
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012648resolve-prefer <family>
12649 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12650 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12651 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12652 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12653
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012654 Default value: ipv6
12655
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012656 Example:
12657
12658 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012659
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012660resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012661 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012662 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012663 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012664 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12665 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012666 configured network, another address is selected.
12667
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012668 Example:
12669
12670 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012671
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012672resolvers <id>
12673 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12674 hostname.
12675
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012676 Example:
12677
12678 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012680 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012681
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012682send-proxy
12683 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12684 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12685 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12686 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012687 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12688 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12689 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12690 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12691 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12692 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12693 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12694 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12695 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12696 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012697 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12698 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012699
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012700send-proxy-v2
12701 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12702 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12703 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12704 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012705 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12706 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12707 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12708 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012709
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012710proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12711 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12712 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012713 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12714 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012715 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12716 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012717 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012718
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012719send-proxy-v2-ssl
12720 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12721 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12722 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12723 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12724 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12725 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12726 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012727 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12728 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012729
12730send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12731 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12732 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12733 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12734 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12735 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12736 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12737 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12738 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012739 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12740 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012742slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012743 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12744 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12745 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12746 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12747 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12748 parameters :
12749
12750 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12751 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12752
12753 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12754 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12755 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12756 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12757
12758 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12759 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12760 seen as failed.
12761
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012762sni <expression>
12763 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12764 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12765 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12766 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012767 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12768 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012769 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012770 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12771 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012772
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012773source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012774source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012775source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012776 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12777 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12778 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12779 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12780
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012781 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12782 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12783 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12784 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12785 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12786 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12787 server.
12788
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012789 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12790 specifying the source address without port(s).
12791
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012792ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012793 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12794 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12795 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12796 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12797 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12798 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012799 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12800 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012801
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012802ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12803 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12804 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12805 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12806
12807ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12808 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12809 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12810 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12811
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012812ssl-reuse
12813 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12814 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12815 default value.
12816 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12817 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12818
12819stick
12820 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12821 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12822 default value.
12823 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12824 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012825
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012826socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012827 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012828 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12829 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12830
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012831tcp-ut <delay>
12832 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12833 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12834 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012835 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012836 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12837 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12838 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12839 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12840 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12841 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12842 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12843 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12844 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12845
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012846tfo
12847 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12848 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12849 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12850 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12851 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012852 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012854track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012855 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12856 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12857 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12858 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012859 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12860
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012861tls-tickets
12862 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12863 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12864 default value.
12865 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12866 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012867
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012868verify [none|required]
12869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012870 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012871 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12872 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012873 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012874 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12875 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12876 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12877 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12878 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12879 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12880 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12881 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012882
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012883verifyhost <hostname>
12884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012885 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12886 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12887 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12888 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12889 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12890 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12891 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12892 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012894weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012895 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12896 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12897 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012898 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12899 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12900 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12901 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12902 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12903 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012904
12905
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129065.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12907-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012908
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012909HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12910using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12911configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012912This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12913can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12914workload.
12915This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12916resolution at run time.
12917Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12918carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12919
12920
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129215.3.1. Global overview
12922----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012923
12924As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12925different steps of the process life:
12926
12927 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12928 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12929 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12930
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012931 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12932 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012933
12934A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12935 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12936 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12937 resolution to know this new IP.
12938
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012939When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012940HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012941SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12942from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12943will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12944will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012945
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012946A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012947 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012948 first valid response.
12949
12950 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12951 servers return an error.
12952
12953
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129545.3.2. The resolvers section
12955----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012956
12957This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012958HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12959contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012960
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012961When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12962uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12963is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12964answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12965
12966When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012967used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012968
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012969 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12970 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12971 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012972
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012973 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12974 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012975
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012976 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12977 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12978 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012979
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012980For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12981following scenarios are possible:
12982
12983 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12984 ignored
12985
12986 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12987 applied
12988
12989 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12990 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12991
12992 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12993 retries the query with a new type
12994
12995 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12996 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012997
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012998As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12999a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013000<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013001
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013002
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013003resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013004 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013005
13006A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13007
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013008accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013009 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013010 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013011 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13012 by RFC 6891)
13013
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013014 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13015
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013016nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13017 DNS server description:
13018 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13019 <ip> : IP address of the server
13020 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13021
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013022parse-resolv-conf
13023 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13024 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13025 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13026
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013027hold <status> <period>
13028 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13029 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013030 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013031 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013032 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13033 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13034 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13035
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013036 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013037
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013038resolve_retries <nb>
13039 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13040 giving up.
13041 Default value: 3
13042
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013043 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13044 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13045 type.
13046
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013047timeout <event> <time>
13048 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13049 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13050 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013051 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13052 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013053 Default value: 1s
13054 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013055 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013056 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013057 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13058 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13059
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013060 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013061
13062 resolvers mydns
13063 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13064 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013065 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013066 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013067 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013068 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013069 hold other 30s
13070 hold refused 30s
13071 hold nx 30s
13072 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013073 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013074 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013075
13076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130776. HTTP header manipulation
13078---------------------------
13079
13080In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13081response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13082request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13083which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013084against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013085
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013086If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13087to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13088but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13089HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13090stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13091because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13092a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13093still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013095This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13096in section 4.2 :
13097
13098 - reqadd <string>
13099 - reqallow <search>
13100 - reqiallow <search>
13101 - reqdel <search>
13102 - reqidel <search>
13103 - reqdeny <search>
13104 - reqideny <search>
13105 - reqpass <search>
13106 - reqipass <search>
13107 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13108 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13109 - reqtarpit <search>
13110 - reqitarpit <search>
13111 - rspadd <string>
13112 - rspdel <search>
13113 - rspidel <search>
13114 - rspdeny <search>
13115 - rspideny <search>
13116 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13117 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13118
13119With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13120is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13121parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13122prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13123Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13124
13125 \t for a tab
13126 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13127 \n for a new line (LF)
13128 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13129 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13130 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13131 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13132 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13133
13134The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13135portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13136above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13137regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
131389 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13139is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13140
13141The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13142after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13143
13144Notes related to these keywords :
13145---------------------------------
13146 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13147 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13148 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13149
13150 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13151 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13152 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13153
13154 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13155 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13156 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13157 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13158 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13159
13160 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13161 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13162 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13163 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13164 useless headers before adding new ones.
13165
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013166 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013167 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13168
13169 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13170 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13171 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13172
13173 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13174 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013175 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013176
13177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13179----------------------------------
13180
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013181HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13183The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13184these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13185but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13186data called patterns.
13187
13188
131897.1. ACL basics
13190---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013191
13192The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13193content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13194from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13195simple :
13196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013197 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013198 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13200 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13203adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013204
13205In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013207 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013208
13209This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13210Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13211and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013212an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13213conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13214as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13215are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013216
13217ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13218'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13219which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13220
13221There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13222performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013224The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13225specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13226this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013227methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13228ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229
13230Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13231 - boolean
13232 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13233 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13234 - string
13235 - data block
13236
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013237Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13238converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13239would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13240The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13241which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13242
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013243Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13244keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13245fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13246which are summarized in the table below :
13247
13248 +---------------------+-----------------+
13249 | Sample or converter | Default |
13250 | output type | matching method |
13251 +---------------------+-----------------+
13252 | boolean | bool |
13253 +---------------------+-----------------+
13254 | integer | int |
13255 +---------------------+-----------------+
13256 | ip | ip |
13257 +---------------------+-----------------+
13258 | string | str |
13259 +---------------------+-----------------+
13260 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13261 +---------------------+-----------------+
13262
13263Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13264matching method, see below.
13265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13267 - boolean
13268 - integer or integer range
13269 - IP address / network
13270 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13271 - regular expression
13272 - hex block
13273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013274The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13275
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013276 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13277 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013279 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013280 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013281 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013282 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13285read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13286if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13287lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13288will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13289beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13290a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13291lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13292exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13293
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013294The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13295parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13296ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13297a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13298check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13299
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013300The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13301socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13302file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13305loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13306
13307 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13308
13309In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13310the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13311case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13312as well.
13313
13314The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13315sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13316do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13317methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13318is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013319obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13321default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13322that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13323string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13324
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013325The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13326By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13327string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13328resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13329server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013330waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013331flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13332function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13335sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13336be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013337
13338 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13339 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13341 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13342 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13343 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013344
13345 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13346 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013347 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013348
13349 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013351
13352 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013355 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013356 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13357
13358 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13359 binary or string samples.
13360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13362 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13365 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13366 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13369 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13372 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13375 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013377 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13378 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013379 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13382 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13383 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013384
13385For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13386request, it is possible to do :
13387
13388 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13389
13390In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13391buffer, one would use the following acl :
13392
13393 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13394
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013395On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13396possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13397
13398 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13401criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13402method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13403to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13404criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13405the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013408the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13409For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13412 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13413 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13414 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013415
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013416
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013417The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13418types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13419combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13420brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13421default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 +-------------------------------------------------+
13424 | Input sample type |
13425 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013426 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13428 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13429 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013430 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013432 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013434 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013436 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013438 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013440 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013442 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013444 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013446 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013448 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013450 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13452 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13453 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013454
13455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134567.1.1. Matching booleans
13457------------------------
13458
13459In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13460Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13461When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13462that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13463
13464Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13465return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13466"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134697.1.2. Matching integers
13470------------------------
13471
13472Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13473enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13474to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13475
13476Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13477matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13478lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013479
13480For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13481unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13482representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13483
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013484As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13485two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13486instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13487ranges and operators.
13488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013489For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013490operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13491Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13492of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013494Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013495
13496 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13497 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13498 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13499 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13500 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013502For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013503
13504 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13505
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013506This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13507
13508 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13509
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135117.1.3. Matching strings
13512-----------------------
13513
13514String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13515different forms :
13516
13517 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013518 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519
13520 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013521 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522
13523 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13524 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13525
13526 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13527 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13528
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013529 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13531 matches.
13532
13533 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13534 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13535 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013536
13537String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13538exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13539characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13540string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13541to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013542before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013543
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013544Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13545(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13546Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13547
13548Example:
13549 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13550 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135537.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13554---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013555
13556Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13557they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13558possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13559passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13560the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013561the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13562match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013563
13564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135657.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13566-------------------------------------
13567
13568It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13569not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13570a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13571to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13572digits may be used upper or lower case.
13573
13574Example :
13575 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13576 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13577
13578
135797.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13580---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013581
13582IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13583netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13584within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013585host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013586difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13587at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13588does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13589parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013590
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013591The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13592abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13593
13594 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13595 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13596 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13597 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13598 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13599 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13600 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13601 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13602
13603Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13604192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13605
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013606IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13607Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13608trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13609IPv6 patterns.
13610
13611HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13612following situations :
13613 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13614 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13615 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13616 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13617 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13618 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13619 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13620 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13621 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13622 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624
136257.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13626----------------------------------
13627
13628Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13629combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13630
13631 - AND (implicit)
13632 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13633 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13640indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13643"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13644requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13645is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13646
13647 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013648 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13649 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13650 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651
13652To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13653and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13654
13655 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13656 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13657 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13658 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13659
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13662 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13663 use_backend www if host_www
13664
13665It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13666expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13667be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13668the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13669
13670 The following rule :
13671
13672 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013673 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674
13675 Can also be written that way :
13676
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013677 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013678
13679It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13680to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13681simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13682sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13683good use is the following :
13684
13685 With named ACLs :
13686
13687 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13688 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13689 monitor fail if site_dead
13690
13691 With anonymous ACLs :
13692
13693 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13694
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013695See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13696keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013697
13698
136997.3. Fetching samples
13700---------------------
13701
13702Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13703against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13704sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13705ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13706of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13707available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13708
13709This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13710Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13711compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13712deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13713
13714The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13715matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13716method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13717indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13718
13719As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13720when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13721mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13722the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13723ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13724
13725Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13726multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13727when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013728incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13729are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13731all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13732
13733Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13734 - name
13735 - name(arg1)
13736 - name(arg1,arg2)
13737
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013738
137397.3.1. Converters
13740-----------------
13741
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013742Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13743of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13744is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13745was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013747unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13748
13749These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13750sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13751the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013753
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013754A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13755support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13756supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13757(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13758bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013761
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001376251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13763 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13764 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13765 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13766 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13767 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13768
13769 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13771 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013772 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13773 frontend http-in
13774 bind *:8081
13775 default_backend servers
13776 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13777 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13778
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013779add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013780 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013781 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013782 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13783 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13786 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13787 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13788 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013789 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013790 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013791
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013792aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13793 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13794 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13795 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13796 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13797 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13798 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13799
13800 Example:
13801 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13802 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13803
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013804and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013805 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013806 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013807 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13808 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013809 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013810 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13811 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013816
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013817b64dec
13818 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13819 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13820
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013821base64
13822 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013823 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013824 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13825
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013826bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013827 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013828 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013829 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013830 presence of a flag).
13831
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013832bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13833 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13834 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013835 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013836
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013837concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13838 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13839 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13840 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13841 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13842 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13843 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13844 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13845 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13846 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13847 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013848 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013849 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013850 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013851
13852 Example:
13853 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13854 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13855 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13856 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013858cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013859 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13860 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013861
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013862crc32([<avalanche>])
13863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13866 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13867 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13868 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13869 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13870 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13871 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13872 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013873 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13874
13875crc32c([<avalanche>])
13876 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13877 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13878 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13879 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13880 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13881 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13882 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13883 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013884
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013885da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013886 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13887 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13888 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13889 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013890 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013891 configuration language.
13892
13893 Example:
13894 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013895 bind *:8881
13896 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013897 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013898
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013899debug
13900 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13901 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13902 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13903
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013904div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013905 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13906 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013907 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013908 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13909 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013910 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013911 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13912 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13913 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13914 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013916 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013917
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013918djb2([<avalanche>])
13919 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13920 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13921 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13922 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13923 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13924 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13925 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013926 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13927 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013928
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013929even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013930 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013931 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13932
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013933field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13934 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13935 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13936 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13937 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13938 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13939 fields.
13940
13941 Example :
13942 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13943 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13944 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13945 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13946 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013947
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013948hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013949 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013950 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013952 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013953
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013954hex2i
13955 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013956 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013958http_date([<offset>])
13959 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13960 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13961 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13962 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13963 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13964 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013966in_table(<table>)
13967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13969 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013970 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013971 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13972
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013973ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13974 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013975 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013976 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13977 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13978 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13979 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13980 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013981
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013982json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013983 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013984 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013985 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013986 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13987 of errors:
13988 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13989 bytes, ...)
13990 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13991 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13992
13993 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13994 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13995 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13996 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13997 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13998 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013999 - "ascii" : never fails;
14000 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14001 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014002 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014003 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014004 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14005 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14006
14007 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014009
14010 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014011 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014012 capture request header user-agent len 150
14013 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014014
14015 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14016 GET / HTTP/1.0
14017 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14018
14019 Output log:
14020 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14021
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014022language(<value>[,<default>])
14023 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14024 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14025 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14026 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14027 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14028 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14029 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14030 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14031 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014032 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014033 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14034 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014035
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014036 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014037
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014038 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14039 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014041 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14042 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14043 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14044 use_backend spanish if es
14045 use_backend french if fr
14046 use_backend english if en
14047 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014048
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014049length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014050 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14051 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14052 type. The result is of type integer.
14053
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014054lower
14055 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14056 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14057 type. The result is of type string.
14058
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014059ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14060 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14061 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14062 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14063 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14064 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14065 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14066
14067 Example :
14068
14069 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014071 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014073map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14074map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14075map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14076 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14077 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14078 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14079 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14080 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14081 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14082 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14083 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014085 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14086 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14087 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014088
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014089 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014090 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014092 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14094 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14095 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014096 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014098 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14100 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14102 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14103 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14104 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14105 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014106 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14108 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14110 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14111 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14112 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14113 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014114
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014115 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14116 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14117 the corresponding match text.
14118
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014119 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14120 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14121 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14122 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14123 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014124
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014125 Example :
14126
14127 # this is a comment and is ignored
14128 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14129 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14130 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14131 | | | `---------- value
14132 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14133 | `---------------------------- key
14134 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14135
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014136mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014137 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14138 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014139 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014140 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014141 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014142 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14143 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14144 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14145 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014146 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014147 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014148
14149mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014150 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014151 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14152 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014153 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014154 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014155 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014156 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14157 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14158 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14159 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014161 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014162
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014163nbsrv
14164 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14165 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14166 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14167 map lookup.
14168
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014169neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014170 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14171 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14172 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14173 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014174
14175not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014176 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014177 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014178 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014179 absence of a flag).
14180
14181odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014182 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014183 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14184
14185or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014186 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014187 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014188 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14189 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14193 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14194 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014195 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014196 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014197
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014198protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14199 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14200 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14201 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14202 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14203 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14204 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14205 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14206 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14207 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14208 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14209 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14210
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014211regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014212 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14213 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14214 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14215 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14216 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14217 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14218 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14219 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14220 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14221 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014222 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14223 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14224 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14225 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014226
14227 Example :
14228
14229 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14230 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14231 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14232 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14233
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014234capture-req(<id>)
14235 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14236 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14237
14238 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014239 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14240 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014241
14242capture-res(<id>)
14243 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14244 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14245
14246 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014247 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14248 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014249
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014250sdbm([<avalanche>])
14251 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14252 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14253 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14254 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14255 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14256 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14257 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014258 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14259 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014260
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014261set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014262 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14263 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14264 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014268 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014272 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014273
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014274sha1
14275 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14276 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14277
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014278strcmp(<var>)
14279 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14280 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14281 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14282 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14283 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14284 shorter).
14285
14286 Example :
14287
14288 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14289 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14290 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14291
14292
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014293sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014294 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14295 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014296 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014297 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14298 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014299 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014300 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14301 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014302 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014303 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14304 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014306 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014307
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014308table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14309 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14310 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14311 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14312 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14313 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14314 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14315
14316
14317table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14318 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14319 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14320 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14321 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14322 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14323 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14324
14325table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014328 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014329 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14330 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14331
14332table_conn_cur(<table>)
14333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14336 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14337 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14338
14339table_conn_rate(<table>)
14340 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14341 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14342 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14343 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14344 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14345
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014346table_gpt0(<table>)
14347 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14348 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14349 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14350 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14351 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14352
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014353table_gpc0(<table>)
14354 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14355 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14356 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14357 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14358 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14359
14360table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14361 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14362 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14363 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14364 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14365 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14366 sample fetch keyword.
14367
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014368table_gpc1(<table>)
14369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14371 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14372 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14373 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14374
14375table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14376 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14377 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14378 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14379 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14380 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14381 sample fetch keyword.
14382
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014383table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014386 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014387 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14388 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14389
14390table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14391 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14392 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14393 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14394 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14395 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14396 keyword.
14397
14398table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014401 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014402 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14403 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14404
14405table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14408 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14409 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14410 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14411 keyword.
14412
14413table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14414 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14415 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014416 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014417 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14418 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14419 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14420 keyword.
14421
14422table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14423 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14424 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014425 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014426 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14427 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14428 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14429 keyword.
14430
14431table_server_id(<table>)
14432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14434 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14435 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14436 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14437 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14438
14439table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14440 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14441 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014442 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014443 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14444 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14445 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14446 keyword.
14447
14448table_sess_rate(<table>)
14449 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14450 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14451 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14452 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14453 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14454 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14455 keyword.
14456
14457table_trackers(<table>)
14458 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14459 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14460 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14461 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14462 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14463 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14464 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14465 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14466 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14467 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14468
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014469upper
14470 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14471 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14472 type. The result is of type string.
14473
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014474url_dec
14475 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14476 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14477
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014478ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014479 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014480 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14481 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14482 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014483 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14484 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14485 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14486 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014487 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014488 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14489 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014490
14491 Example:
14492 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14493 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14494
14495 message Point {
14496 int32 latitude = 1;
14497 int32 longitude = 2;
14498 }
14499
14500 message PPoint {
14501 Point point = 59;
14502 }
14503
14504 message Rectangle {
14505 // One corner of the rectangle.
14506 PPoint lo = 48;
14507 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14508 PPoint hi = 49;
14509 }
14510
14511 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14512 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14513 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14514
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014515 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14516 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014517 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014518 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14519
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014520 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014521
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014522 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014523
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014524 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014525 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14526 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14527
14528 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14529 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14530 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14531
14532 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14533 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14534 interpret the previous binary sample.
14535
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014536
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014537unset-var(<var name>)
14538 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14539 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14540 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14541 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14542 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14543 response),
14544 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14545 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14546 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14547 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14548
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014549utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14550 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14551 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14552 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14553 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14554 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14555 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14556
14557 Example :
14558
14559 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014560 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014561 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14562
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014563word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14564 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14565 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14566 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14567 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14568 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14569
14570 Example :
14571 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14572 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14573 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14574 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14575 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014576
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014577wt6([<avalanche>])
14578 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14579 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14580 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14581 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14582 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14583 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14584 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014585 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14586 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014587
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014588xor(<value>)
14589 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014590 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014591 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014592 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014596 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14598 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014599 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014600 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014601
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014602xxh32([<seed>])
14603 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14604 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14605 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14606 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14607 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14608 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14609 as cryptographically secure.
14610
14611xxh64([<seed>])
14612 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14613 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14614 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14615 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14616 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14617 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14618 as cryptographically secure.
14619
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014620
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014622--------------------------------------------
14623
14624A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14625not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14626"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14627The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14628
14629always_false : boolean
14630 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14631 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14632
14633always_true : boolean
14634 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14635 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14636
14637avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014638 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14640 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14641 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14642 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14643 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14644 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14645 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14646 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14647 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14648 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14649 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14650 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14651 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014654 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14655 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14656 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14657 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014658 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14659
14660be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14662 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14663 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14664 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14665 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014666 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14667 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014668
14669 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14670 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14671 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14675 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14676 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014677 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14679 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014680
14681 Example :
14682 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14683 backend dynamic
14684 mode http
14685 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14686 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014687
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014688bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014689 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14690 of the string.
14691
14692bool(<bool>) : bool
14693 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14694 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014696connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014698 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14700 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014701
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014702 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014703 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014704 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14705
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014706 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14707 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014708
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014709 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014710 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014712 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014713 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014715 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014716
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014717 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14718 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014720 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014721
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014722cpu_calls : integer
14723 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14724 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14725 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14726 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14727 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14728 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14729
14730cpu_ns_avg : integer
14731 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14732 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14733 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14734 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14735 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14736 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14737 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14738 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14739 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14740 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14741 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14742
14743cpu_ns_tot : integer
14744 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14745 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14746 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14747 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14748 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14749 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14750 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14751 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14752 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14753 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14754 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14755 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14756 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14757
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014758date([<offset>]) : integer
14759 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14760 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14761 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14762 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014763 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14764
14765 Example :
14766
14767 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14768 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014769
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014770date_us : integer
14771 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14772 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14773 from the same timeval structure.
14774
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014775distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14776 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14777 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14778 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14779 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14780 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14781 list of supported tokens.
14782
14783distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14784 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14785 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14786 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14787 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14788 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14789 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14790 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14791 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14792 supported tokens.
14793
14794 Example :
14795 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14796 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14797 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14798 # send large files to the big farm
14799 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14800
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014801env(<name>) : string
14802 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14803 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14804 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14805 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14806 certain way.
14807
14808 Examples :
14809 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14810 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14811
14812 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14813 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14816 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014817 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14818 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14820 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014821 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14823 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014824
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014825fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14827 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14828 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14831 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14832 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14833 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14834 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14835 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14836 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14837 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14838 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014839
14840 Example :
14841 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14842 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14843 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14844 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14845 frontend mail
14846 bind :25
14847 mode tcp
14848 maxconn 100
14849 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14850 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14851 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14852 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014853
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014854hostname : string
14855 Returns the system hostname.
14856
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014857int(<integer>) : signed integer
14858 Returns a signed integer.
14859
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014860ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14861 Returns an ipv4.
14862
14863ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14864 Returns an ipv6.
14865
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014866lat_ns_avg : integer
14867 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14868 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14869 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14870 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14871 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14872 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14873 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14874 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14875 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14876 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14877 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14878 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14879 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14880 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14881
14882lat_ns_tot : integer
14883 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14884 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14885 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14886 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14887 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14888 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14889 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14890 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14891 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14892 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14893 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14894 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14895 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14896 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14897 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14898 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14899 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14900 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14901 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14902
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014903meth(<method>) : method
14904 Returns a method.
14905
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014906nbproc : integer
14907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14908 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14909 and debugging purposes.
14910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14913 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14914 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014915 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14916 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14917 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014918
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014919prio_class : integer
14920 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14921 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14922 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14923
14924prio_offset : integer
14925 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14926 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14927 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14928 set-priority-offset".
14929
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014930proc : integer
14931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14932 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14933 debugging purposes.
14934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014936 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14937 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14938 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14940 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14941 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14942 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14943 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14944
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014945rand([<range>]) : integer
14946 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14947 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14948 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14949 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14950 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14951
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014952uuid([<version>]) : string
14953 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14954 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14955 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14958 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14959 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14960 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14961 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14962 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014963 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14964 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14965
14966srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14968 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14969 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14970 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14971 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14972 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14973 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14974
14975 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14976 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977
14978srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14979 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14980 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14981 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014982 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014983 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14984 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14985 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14986
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014987srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14988 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14989 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14990 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14991 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14992 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14993 fetch methods.
14994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14996 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14997 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014998 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15000 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015001 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002 overloading servers).
15003
15004 Example :
15005 # Redirect to a separate back
15006 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15007 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15008 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15009
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015010stopping : boolean
15011 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15012 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15013 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15014
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015015str(<string>) : string
15016 Returns a string.
15017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015018table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15019 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15020 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15021
15022table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15023 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15024 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15025 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15026
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015027thread : integer
15028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15029 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15030 and debugging purposes.
15031
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015032var(<var-name>) : undefined
15033 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015034 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15035 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015036 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015037 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15038 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015039 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015040 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15041 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015042 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015043 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015044
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150457.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046----------------------------------
15047
15048The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15049closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15050methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15051sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15052TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015053the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15054counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015055"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15056used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15057can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15058Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15059table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15060tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15061currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015063bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015064 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15065 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15066 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068be_id : integer
15069 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15070 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15071
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015072be_name : string
15073 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15074 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076dst : ip
15077 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15078 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15079 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15080 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015081 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15082 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15083 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15084 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15085 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15086 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087
15088dst_conn : integer
15089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15090 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15091 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15092 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15093 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15094 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15095 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15096 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015097
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015098dst_is_local : boolean
15099 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15100 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15101 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15102 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015103 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015104 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15105 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15106 it only once per connection.
15107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015108dst_port : integer
15109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15110 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15111 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15112 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15113 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15114 an HTTP header.
15115
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015116fc_http_major : integer
15117 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15118 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15119 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15120
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015121fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15122 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15123 header.
15124
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015125fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15126 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15127 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15128 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15129 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15130 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15131 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15132
15133fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15134 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15135 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15136 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15137 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15138 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15139 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15140
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015141fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015142 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15143 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15144 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15145 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15146
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015147fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015148 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15149 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15150 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15151 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15152
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015153fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015154 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15155 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15156 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15157 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15158
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015159fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015160 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15161 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15162 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15163 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15164
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015165fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015166 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15167 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15168 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15169 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15170
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015171fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015172 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15173 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15174 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15175 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15176
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015177fe_defbe : string
15178 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15179 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181fe_id : integer
15182 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015183 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15185
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015186fe_name : string
15187 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15188 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15189 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015191sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015192sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15193sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15194sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015195 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15196 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15197 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015199sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015200sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15201sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15202sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015203 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15204 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15205 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15206
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015207sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015208sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15209sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15210sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015211 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15212 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015213 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15214 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15215 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015216
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015217 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015218 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15219 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015220 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15221 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15222 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015223 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15224 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15225
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015226sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15227sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15228sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15229sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15230 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15231 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15232 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15233 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15234 when a first ACL was verified.
15235
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015236sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015237sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15238sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15239sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015240 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015241 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015243sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015244sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15245sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15246sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015247 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15248 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15249 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15250
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015251sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015252sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15253sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15254sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015255 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15256 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15257 See also src_conn_rate.
15258
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015259sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015260sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15261sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15262sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015263 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015264 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015265
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015266sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15267sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15268sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15269sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15270 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15271 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15272
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015273sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15274sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15275sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15276sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15277 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15278 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015280sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015281sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15282sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15283sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015284 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15285 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15286 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015287 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15288 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15289 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015290
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015291sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15292sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15295 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15296 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15297 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15298 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15299 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15300 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015302sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015303sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15304sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15305sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015307 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15308 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15309
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015310sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015311sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15312sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15313sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015314 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15315 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15316 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15317 src_http_err_rate.
15318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015319sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015320sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15321sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15322sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015323 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015324 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15325 src_http_req_cnt.
15326
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015327sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015328sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15329sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15330sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015331 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15332 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15333 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15334 src_http_req_rate.
15335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015336sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015337sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15338sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15339sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015340 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015341 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15342 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15343 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15344 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015345
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015346 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015347 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15348 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015349 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15350
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015351sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15352sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15353sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15354sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15355 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15356 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15357 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15358 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15359 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015361sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015362sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15363sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15364sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015365 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15366 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15367 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015369sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015370sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15371sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15372sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015373 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15374 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15375 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015377sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015378sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15379sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15380sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015382 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15383 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15384 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015385 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015386 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15387
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015388sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015389sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15390sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15391sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015392 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15393 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15394 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15395 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15396 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015397 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015398
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015399sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015400sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15401sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15402sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015403 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15404 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15405 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15406
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015407sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015408sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15409sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15410sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015411 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15412 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015413 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015414 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15415 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15417 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15418 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420so_id : integer
15421 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15422 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15423 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015426 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015427 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15428 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15429 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015430 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15431 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15432 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015433 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15434 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15435 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15436 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15437 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15438 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15439 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015440
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015441 Example:
15442 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15443 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15446 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15447 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15448 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015449 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15452 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15453 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015454 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015455 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15458 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15459 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15460 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15461 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15462 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15463 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015464
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015465 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015466 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15467 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15468 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15469 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015470 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015471 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15472 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15473
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015474src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15475 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15476 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15477 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15478 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15479 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15480 was verified.
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015483 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015485 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015486 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015489 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15491 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015492 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15495 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15496 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15497 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015498 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015501 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015503 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015504 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015505
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015506src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15507 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15508 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15509 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15510 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15511
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015512src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15513 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15514 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15515 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15516 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015519 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015521 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15522 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015523 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15524 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15525 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015526
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015527src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15528 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15529 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15530 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15531 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15532 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15533 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15534 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015537 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015539 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015540 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15544 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15545 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15546 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15547 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015548 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015551 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15553 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15557 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15558 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15559 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015560 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015561 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15564 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15565 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15566 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015567 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15569 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015570
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015571 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015572 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015573 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015574 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015575
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015576src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15577 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15578 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15579 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15580 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15581 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15582 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15583
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015584src_is_local : boolean
15585 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15586 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15587 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15588 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015589 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015590 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15591 once per connection.
15592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015594 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15595 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15596 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15597 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15598 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015601 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15602 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15603 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15604 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15605 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607src_port : integer
15608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15609 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15610 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15611 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015614 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15616 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15617 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015618 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15621 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15622 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15623 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15624 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015625 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15628 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15629 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15630 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15631 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15632 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15633 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15634 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15635 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015636
15637 Example :
15638 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15639 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15640 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15641 listen ssh
15642 bind :22
15643 mode tcp
15644 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015645 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015647 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649srv_id : integer
15650 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15651 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15652 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015653
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15658closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15659when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15660usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015661future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015662
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001566351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15664 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15665 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15666 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15667 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15668 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15669
15670 Example :
15671 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15672 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15673 # the request.
15674 frontend http-in
15675 bind *:8081
15676 default_backend servers
15677 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15678 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15679
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015680ssl_bc : boolean
15681 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15682 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15683 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15684
15685ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15686 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15687 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15688
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015689ssl_bc_alpn : string
15690 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15691 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015692 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015693 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15694 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15695 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15696 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15697 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15698 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15699
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015700ssl_bc_cipher : string
15701 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15702 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15703
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015704ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15705 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15706 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15707 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15708
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015709ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15710 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15711 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15712 session or a TLS ticket.
15713
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015714ssl_bc_npn : string
15715 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15716 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015717 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015718 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15719 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15720 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15721 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15722 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15723
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015724ssl_bc_protocol : string
15725 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15726 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15727
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015728ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015729 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015730 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15731 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015732
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015733ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15734 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15735 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15736 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15737
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015738ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15739 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15740 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15741 if session was reused or not.
15742
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015743ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15744 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15745 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15746 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15747 BoringSSL.
15748
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015749ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15750 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15751 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15755 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15756 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15757 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15758 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15761 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15762 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15763 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15764 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015765
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015766ssl_c_der : binary
15767 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15768 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15769 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771ssl_c_err : integer
15772 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15773 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15774 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15775 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15776 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15779 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15780 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15781 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15782 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15783 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15784 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15785 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15786 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788ssl_c_key_alg : string
15789 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15790 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15791 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793ssl_c_notafter : string
15794 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15795 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15796 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798ssl_c_notbefore : string
15799 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15800 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15801 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15804 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15805 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15806 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15807 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15808 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15809 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15810 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15811 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813ssl_c_serial : binary
15814 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15815 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15816 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15819 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15820 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15821 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015822 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15823 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15824
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015825 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015826 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15829 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15830 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15831 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833ssl_c_used : boolean
15834 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15835 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837ssl_c_verify : integer
15838 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15839 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15840 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15841 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843ssl_c_version : integer
15844 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15845 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015846
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015847ssl_f_der : binary
15848 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15849 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15850 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15853 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15854 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15855 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15856 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015857 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15859 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15860 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862ssl_f_key_alg : string
15863 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15864 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15865 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867ssl_f_notafter : string
15868 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15869 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15870 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872ssl_f_notbefore : string
15873 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15874 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15875 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15878 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15879 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15880 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15881 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15882 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15883 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15884 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15885 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887ssl_f_serial : binary
15888 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15889 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15890 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015891
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015892ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15893 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15894 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15895 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15898 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15899 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15900 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902ssl_f_version : integer
15903 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15904 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15905
15906ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015907 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15908 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15909 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 Example :
15912 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15913 listen http-https
15914 bind :80
15915 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15916 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15917
15918ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15919 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15920 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15921
15922ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015923 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15925 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15926 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15927 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15928 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15929 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15930 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15931 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933ssl_fc_cipher : string
15934 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15935 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015936
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015937ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15938 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15939 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015940 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015941
15942ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15943 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15944 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015945 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015946
15947ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15948 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15949 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15950 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015951 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015952 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015953
15954ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15955 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15956 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015957 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015958
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015959ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15960 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15961 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15962 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015965 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15966 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015967 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15968 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15969 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15970 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015971
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015972ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15973 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15974 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15975 wait until the handshake happened.
15976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15978 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015979 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15980 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015981 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015982 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015983
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015984ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015985 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015986 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15987 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015990 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15992 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15993 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15994 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15995 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15996 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15997 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999ssl_fc_protocol : string
16000 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16001 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016002
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016003ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016004 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016005 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16006 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016007
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016008ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16009 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16010 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16011 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16014 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16015 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16016 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16017 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016018
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016019ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16020 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16021 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16022 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16023 BoringSSL.
16024
16025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026ssl_fc_sni : string
16027 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16028 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16029 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16030 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16031 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16032
16033 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16034 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16035 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016036 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016037 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16041 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16044 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16045 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016046
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016047
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160487.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16052sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16053only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16054For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16055be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16056can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16057sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16058for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16059content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016062 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16064 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16067 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016068 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016070
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016071req.hdrs : string
16072 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16073 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16074 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16075 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16076
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016077req.hdrs_bin : binary
16078 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16079 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16080 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16081 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16082 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16083 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16084
16085 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16086
16087 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16088 str: <int:length><bytes>
16089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090req.len : integer
16091req_len : integer (deprecated)
16092 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16093 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16094 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16095 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16096 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16097 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16098 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16099 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16102 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016103 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16104 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16105 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16106 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108 ACL alternatives :
16109 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16112 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16113 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16114 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16115 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117 ACL alternatives :
16118 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122req.proto_http : boolean
16123req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16124 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16125 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16126 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16127 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16128 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16129 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16130 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 Example:
16133 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16134 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16135 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016136 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016138req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16139rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16140 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16141 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16142 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16143 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16144 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16145 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16146 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16149 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16150 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16151 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16152 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16153 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 ACL derivatives :
16156 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158 Example :
16159 listen tse-farm
16160 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16161 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16162 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16163 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16164 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16165 persist rdp-cookie
16166 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16167 # This is only useful makes sense if
16168 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16169 stick-table type string size 204800
16170 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16171 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16172 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16175 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16178rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16179 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16180 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16181 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16182 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184 ACL derivatives :
16185 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016186
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016187req.ssl_alpn : string
16188 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16189 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16190 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16191 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16192 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16193 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016194 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016195
16196 Examples :
16197 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16198 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16199 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016200 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016201 default_backend bk_default
16202
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016203req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16204 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16205 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016206 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16207 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16208 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16209 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16210 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16213req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16214 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16215 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16216 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16217 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16218 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16219 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16220 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222req.ssl_sni : string
16223req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16224 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16225 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16226 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16227 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16228 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16229 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16230 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16231 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16232 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16233 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16234 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16235 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 ACL derivatives :
16238 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 Examples :
16241 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16242 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16243 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16244 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16245 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016246
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016247req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16248 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16249 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16250 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16251 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16252 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16253 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16254 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16255 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16256 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258req.ssl_ver : integer
16259req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16260 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16261 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16262 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16263 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16264 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16265 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16266 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016267 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 ACL derivatives :
16271 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016272
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016273res.len : integer
16274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16275 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16276 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16277 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16278 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16279 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16280 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16281 content inspection.
16282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16284 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016285 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16286 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16287 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16288 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016290res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16291 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16292 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16293 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16294 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016297
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016298res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16299rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16300 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16301 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16302 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16303 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16304 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16305 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16306 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016308wait_end : boolean
16309 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16310 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016311 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16313 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016314 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016315 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16316 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318 Examples :
16319 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16320 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16321 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16324 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16325 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16326 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16327 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16328 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16329 tcp-request content reject
16330
16331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333--------------------------------------
16334
16335It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16336This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16337data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16338its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16339HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16340content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16341to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16342more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16343response are indexed.
16344
16345base : string
16346 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16347 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16348 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16349 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16350 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16351 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16352 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16353 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16354
16355 ACL derivatives :
16356 base : exact string match
16357 base_beg : prefix match
16358 base_dir : subdir match
16359 base_dom : domain match
16360 base_end : suffix match
16361 base_len : length match
16362 base_reg : regex match
16363 base_sub : substring match
16364
16365base32 : integer
16366 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16367 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16368 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016369 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16370 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16371 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016372
16373base32+src : binary
16374 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16375 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16376 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16377 per-URL counters.
16378
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016379capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16380 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16381 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16382 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16383
16384capture.req.method : string
16385 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16386 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16387 because it's allocated.
16388
16389capture.req.uri : string
16390 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16391 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16392 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16393 allocated.
16394
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016395capture.req.ver : string
16396 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16397 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16398 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16399
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016400capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16401 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16402 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16403 The first entry is an index of 0.
16404 See also: "capture response header"
16405
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016406capture.res.ver : string
16407 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16408 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16409 persistent flag.
16410
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016411req.body : binary
16412 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16413 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16414 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16415 the first chunk is analyzed.
16416
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016417req.body_param([<name>) : string
16418 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16419 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16420 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16421 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16422 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16423 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16424 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16425 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16426 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16427 given.
16428
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016429req.body_len : integer
16430 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16431 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16432 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16433 "option http-buffer-request".
16434
16435req.body_size : integer
16436 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16437 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16438 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16439 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16440 "option http-buffer-request".
16441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442req.cook([<name>]) : string
16443cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16444 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16445 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16446 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16447 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16448 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16449 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16450 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16451 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16452
16453 ACL derivatives :
16454 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16455 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16456 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16457 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16458 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16459 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16460 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16461 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16464cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16465 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16466 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16469cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16470 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16471 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16472 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16473 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016475cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16476 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16477 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16478 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16479 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016480 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016481 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16482 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16483 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16484 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016486hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16487 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16488 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16489 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16490 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016491 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016493req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16494 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16495 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16496 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16497 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16498 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16499 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16500 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16501 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16504 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16505 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16506 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16507 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16510 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16511 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16512 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16513 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16514 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16515 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16516 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16517 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016518 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016519 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016520 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016522 ACL derivatives :
16523 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16524 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16525 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16526 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16527 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16528 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16529 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16530 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16531
16532req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16533hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16534 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16535 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16536 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16537 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16538 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16539 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16540 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16541 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16542 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16543
16544req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16545hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16546 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16547 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16548 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16549 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16550 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016551 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16553 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16554
16555req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16556hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16557 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16558 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16559 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16560 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16561 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16562 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16563 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16564
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016565
16566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016567http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16568 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16569 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16570 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16571 basic auth is supported.
16572
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016573http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16574 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16575 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16576 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16577 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16579 basic auth is supported.
16580
16581 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016582 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16583 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16584 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16585 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586
16587http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016588 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16589 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16591 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593method : integer + string
16594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16595 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16596 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16597 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16598 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16599 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16600 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602 ACL derivatives :
16603 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016605 Example :
16606 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16607 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16608 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610path : string
16611 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16612 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16613 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16614 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16615 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016616 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016619 ACL derivatives :
16620 path : exact string match
16621 path_beg : prefix match
16622 path_dir : subdir match
16623 path_dom : domain match
16624 path_end : suffix match
16625 path_len : length match
16626 path_reg : regex match
16627 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016628
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016629query : string
16630 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16631 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16632 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16633 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016634 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016635 which stops before the question mark.
16636
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016637req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16638 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16639 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16640 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16641 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643req.ver : string
16644req_ver : string (deprecated)
16645 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16646 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16647 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 ACL derivatives :
16650 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652res.comp : boolean
16653 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16654 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16655 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657res.comp_algo : string
16658 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16659 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16660 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016662res.cook([<name>]) : string
16663scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16664 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16665 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16666 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668 ACL derivatives :
16669 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16672scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16673 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16674 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16675 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16678scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16679 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16680 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16681 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16684 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16685 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16686 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16687 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16688 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16689 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16690 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16691 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16692 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016694res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16695 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16696 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16697 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16698 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16699 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16702shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16703 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16704 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16705 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16706 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16707 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16708 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16709 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16710 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712 ACL derivatives :
16713 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16714 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16715 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16716 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16717 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16718 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16719 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16720 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16721
16722res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16723shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16725 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16726 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16727 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16728 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16731shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16732 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16733 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16734 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16735 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16736 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16737 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016738
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016739res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16740 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16741 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16742 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16743 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016745res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16746shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16747 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16748 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16749 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16750 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16751 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16752 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754res.ver : string
16755resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16756 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16757 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759 ACL derivatives :
16760 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16763 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16764 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016765 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16769 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771status : integer
16772 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16773 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16774 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016775
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016776unique-id : string
16777 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16778 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16779 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16780 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16781 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16782 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784url : string
16785 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16786 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16787 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16788 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16789 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16790 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16791 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793 ACL derivatives :
16794 url : exact string match
16795 url_beg : prefix match
16796 url_dir : subdir match
16797 url_dom : domain match
16798 url_end : suffix match
16799 url_len : length match
16800 url_reg : regex match
16801 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803url_ip : ip
16804 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16805 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16806 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16807 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16808 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16809 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16810 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812url_port : integer
16813 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16814 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16815 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16816 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016817
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016818urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16819url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16821 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016822 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16823 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16824 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16825 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16827 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016828 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16829 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 ACL derivatives :
16832 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16833 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16834 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16835 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16836 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16837 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16838 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16839 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016840
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842 Example :
16843 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16844 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16845 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16846 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016847
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016848urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16850 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16851 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016852
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016853url32 : integer
16854 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16855 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16856 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16857 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16858 is an unsigned integer.
16859
16860url32+src : binary
16861 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16862 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16863 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16864
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168667.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016867---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016869Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16870every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016871order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016873ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16874---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016875FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016876HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016877HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16878HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016879HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16880HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16881HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16882HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16883LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016885METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016886METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16887METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16888METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16889METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016890METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016891METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016892RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016893REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016894TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016895WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16896---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016897
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168998. Logging
16900----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016902One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16903provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16904very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16905provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16906state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016907to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016908headers.
16909
16910In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16911about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16912send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16913
16914 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16915 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16916 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16917 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16918 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016919 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016920 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921
16922The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16923allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16924as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16925while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16926real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16927delay.
16928
16929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169308.1. Log levels
16931---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016932
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016933TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016934source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016935HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16936in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16937track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16938syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16939about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016940
16941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169428.2. Log formats
16943----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016944
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016945HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016946and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16947slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16948options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949
16950 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16951 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16952 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16953 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16954 extents.
16955
16956 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16957 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16958 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16959 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16960 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16961
16962 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16963 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16964 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16965 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16966 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16967
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016968 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16969 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16970 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16971 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16972
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016973 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16976specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16977field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16978servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16979always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16980identifier.
16981
16982Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16983 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16984 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16985 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16986 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16987
16988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169898.2.1. Default log format
16990-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016991
16992This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16993as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16994format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16995
16996 Example :
16997 listen www
16998 mode http
16999 log global
17000 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17001
17002 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17003 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17004 (www/HTTP)
17005
17006 Field Format Extract from the example above
17007 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17008 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17009 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17010 4 'to' to
17011 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17012 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17013
17014Detailed fields description :
17015 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17016 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17017 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17018 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17019 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17020 and processed the connection.
17021 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17022
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017023In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17024"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17025connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017027It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17028will eventually disappear.
17029
17030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170318.2.2. TCP log format
17032---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033
17034The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17035is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17036information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17037counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17038emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17039environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17040the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17041sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017042specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17043not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17044fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17045marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046
17047 Example :
17048 frontend fnt
17049 mode tcp
17050 option tcplog
17051 log global
17052 default_backend bck
17053
17054 backend bck
17055 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17056
17057 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17058 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17059 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17060
17061 Field Format Extract from the example above
17062 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17063 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17064 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17065 4 frontend_name fnt
17066 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17067 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17068 7 bytes_read* 212
17069 8 termination_state --
17070 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17071 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17072
17073Detailed fields description :
17074 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017075 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17076 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17077 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017078 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017079 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017080 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017081
17082 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017083 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17084 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17085 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017086
17087 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17088 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17089 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017090 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17091 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17092 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17093 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017094
17095 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17096 and processed the connection.
17097
17098 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17099 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17100 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17101 applications.
17102
17103 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17104 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17105 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17106 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17107 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17108
17109 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17110 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17111 See "Timers" below for more details.
17112
17113 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17114 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17115 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17116 "Timers" below for more details.
17117
17118 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017119 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017120 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17121 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17122 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17123 details.
17124
17125 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17126 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17127 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17128 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17129 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17130
17131 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17132 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17133 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17134 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17135 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17136 for more details.
17137
17138 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017139 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017140 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17141 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17142 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017143 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144
17145 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17146 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17147 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17148 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17149 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17150 caused by a denial of service attack.
17151
17152 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17153 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17154 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17155 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17156 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17157 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17158 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17159 denial of service attack.
17160
17161 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17162 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17163 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17164 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17165 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17166 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17167 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17168 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17169 be processed than on other servers.
17170
17171 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17172 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17173 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17174 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17175 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17176 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17177 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17178 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17179 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17180 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17181 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17182 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17183 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17184
17185 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17186 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17187 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17188 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17189 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17190 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017191 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017192 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17193
17194 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17195 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17196 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17197 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17198 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17199 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017200 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17202 occurs.
17203
17204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172058.2.3. HTTP log format
17206----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207
17208The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17209is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17210the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17211are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17212emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17213generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17214"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17215which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017216frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17217is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017218
17219Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17220slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17221with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17222
17223 Example :
17224 frontend http-in
17225 mode http
17226 option httplog
17227 log global
17228 default_backend bck
17229
17230 backend static
17231 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17232
17233 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17234 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17235 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017236 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237
17238 Field Format Extract from the example above
17239 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17240 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017241 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242 4 frontend_name http-in
17243 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017244 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245 7 status_code 200
17246 8 bytes_read* 2750
17247 9 captured_request_cookie -
17248 10 captured_response_cookie -
17249 11 termination_state ----
17250 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17251 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17252 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17253 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17254 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017255
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017256Detailed fields description :
17257 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017258 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17259 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17260 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017261 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017262 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017263 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264
17265 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017266 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17267 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17268 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017270 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17271 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272
17273 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17274 and processed the connection.
17275
17276 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17277 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17278 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17279
17280 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17281 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17282 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17283 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17284 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17285 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17286
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017287 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17288 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17289 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017290 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017291 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17292 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017293 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17294 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
17296 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17297 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017298 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299
17300 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17301 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017302 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17303 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017304
17305 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17306 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17307 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17308 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17309 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017310 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17311 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017313 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17314 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17315 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17316 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17317 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17318 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17319 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017320 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321
17322 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17323 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17324 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17325
17326 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17327 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017328 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017329 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17330 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17331 overflowing.
17332
17333 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17334 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17335 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17336 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17337 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17338 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17339 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17340 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17341
17342 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17343 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17344 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17345 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17346 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17347 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17348 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17349 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17350
17351 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17352 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17353 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17354 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17355 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17356 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17357 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17358
17359 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017360 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017361 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17362 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17363 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017364 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017365 system.
17366
17367 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17368 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17369 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17370 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17371 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17372 caused by a denial of service attack.
17373
17374 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17375 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17376 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17377 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17378 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17379 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17380 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17381 denial of service attack.
17382
17383 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17384 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17385 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17386 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17387 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17388 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17389 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17390 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17391 processed than on other servers.
17392
17393 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17394 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17395 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17396 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17397 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17398 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17399 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17400 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17401 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17402 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17403 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17404 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17405 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17406
17407 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17408 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17409 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17410 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17411 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17412 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017413 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17415
17416 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17417 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17418 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17419 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17420 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17421 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017422 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17424 occurs.
17425
17426 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17427 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17428 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17429 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17430 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17431 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17432 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17433 cookies" below for more details.
17434
17435 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17436 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17437 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17438 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17439 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17440 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17441 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17442 and cookies" below for more details.
17443
17444 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17445 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17446 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17447 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17448 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17449 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17450 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17451 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17452
17453
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200174548.2.4. Custom log format
17455------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017456
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017457The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017458mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017460HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017461Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17462separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17463prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17464
17465Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17466variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017467("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017468
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017469If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017470as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017471less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17472the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17473
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017474Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017475In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017476in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017477
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017478Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17479'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17480https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17481such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017483Flags are :
17484 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017485 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017486 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17487 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017488
17489 Example:
17490
17491 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17492 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17493
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017494 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17495
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017496At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017498 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17499 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017500
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017501the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017502
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017503 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17504 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17505 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017506
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017507and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17508
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017509 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17510 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017511
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017512Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17513
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017514 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017515 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017516 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17517 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17518 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017519 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17520 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17521 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017522 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017523 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17524 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017525 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017526 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17527 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017528 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017529 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017530 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017531 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017532 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017533 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017534 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017535 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17536 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17537 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17538 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17539 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017540 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017541 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17542 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017543 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017544 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17545 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017546 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17547 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17548 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017549 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017550 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17551 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017552 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017553 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17554 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17555 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017556 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017557 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017558 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17559 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17560 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17561 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017562 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017563 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017564 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017565 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017566 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017567 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017568 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17569 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17570 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017571 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017572 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17573 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017574 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017575 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17576 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017577 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017578 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017579 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017580 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017581
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017582 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017583
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017584
175858.2.5. Error log format
17586-----------------------
17587
17588When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17589protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17590By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17591"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017592will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017593logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17594
17595The format looks like this :
17596
17597 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17598 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17599 Connection error during SSL handshake
17600
17601 Field Format Extract from the example above
17602 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17603 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17604 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17605 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17606 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17607
17608These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17609failures.
17610
17611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176128.3. Advanced logging options
17613-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017614
17615Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17616just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17617options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17618for more information about their usage.
17619
17620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176218.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17622------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623
17624It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17625haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17626commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17627monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17628ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17629
17630 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17631 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17632 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17633 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17634
17635 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17636 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17637 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017638 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017639 such as other load-balancers.
17640
17641 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17642 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17643 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17644
17645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176468.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17647----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648
17649The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17650what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17651or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017652"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017653just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17654log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17655after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17656is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17657with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17658with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17659
17660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176618.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17662------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017663
17664Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17665for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17666"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17667retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17668raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17669a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17670file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17671you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17672"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17673
17674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176758.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17676--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017677
17678Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17679multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17680them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17681"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17682logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17683error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17684and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17685too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17686useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17687alternative.
17688
17689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176908.4. Timing events
17691------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017692
17693Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17694reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17695the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17696frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017697mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17698addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17699
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017700Timings events in HTTP mode:
17701
17702 first request 2nd request
17703 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17704 t tr t tr ...
17705 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17706 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17707 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17708 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17709 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17710
17711Timings events in TCP mode:
17712
17713 TCP session
17714 |<----------------->|
17715 t t
17716 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17717 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17718 |<------ Tt ------->|
17719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017720 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017721 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017722 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17723 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17724 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017726 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17727 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17728 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17729 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017731 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17732 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17733 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017734 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17735 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17736 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17737 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17738 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17739 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017740
17741 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17742 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17743 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17744 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17745 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17746 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17747 request typed by hand during a test.
17748
17749 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17750 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017751 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017752 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17753 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17754 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17755 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017756
17757 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17758 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17759 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17760 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17761 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17762
17763 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17764 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17765 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17766 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17767 connection never established.
17768
17769 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17770 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17771 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17772 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17773 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17774 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17775 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17776 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17777 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17778 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17779 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17780
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017781 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17782 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17783 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17784 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17785 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17786 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17787
17788 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17789
17790 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17791 "Ta" can never be negative.
17792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017793 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17794 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017795 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17796 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017797 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017799 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800
17801 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017802 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17803 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017804
17805These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17806protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17807that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017808due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17809"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17810that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017811
17812Most common cases :
17813
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017814 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17815 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17816 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17817 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17818 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17819 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17820 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17821 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17822 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17823 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17824 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017825 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017826
17827 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17828 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17829 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17830 of ms on remote networks.
17831
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017832 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17833 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17834 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017836 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17837 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17838 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17839 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17840 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17841 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17842 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17843 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17844 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017845
17846Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17847
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017848 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017849 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017850 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017851
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017852 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017853 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17854 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17855
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017856 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017857 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17858 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17859 flags.
17860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017861 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17862 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17864 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17865 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17866 the client connection was maintained open.
17867
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017868 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017869 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017870 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017871 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17872
17873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178748.5. Session state at disconnection
17875-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017876
17877TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17878"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
178792-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17880each of which has a special meaning :
17881
17882 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17883 session to terminate :
17884
17885 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17886
17887 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17888 server explicitly refused it.
17889
17890 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17891 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17892 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17893 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017894 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017895
17896 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17897 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898
17899 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17900 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17901 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17902 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17903 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17904
17905 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17906 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17907 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17908 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17909 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17910
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017911 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17912 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17913
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017914 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17915 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17916 backup connections when going up.
17917
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017918 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17919
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017920 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17921 send or receive data.
17922
17923 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17924 send or receive data.
17925
17926 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17927 with nothing left in the buffers.
17928
17929 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17930
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017931 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017932 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17933
17934 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17935 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17936 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17937 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17938 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17939
17940 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17941 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17942
17943 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17944 server (HTTP only).
17945
17946 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17947
17948 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17949 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17950 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17951
17952 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17953 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17954 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17955
17956 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17957
17958 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17959 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17960
17961 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17962 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17963 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17964
17965 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17966 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017967 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17968 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017969
17970 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17971 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17972 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17973 another server.
17974
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017975 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017976 server.
17977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017978 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17979 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17980 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17981 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17982
17983 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17984 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17985 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17986 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17987
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017988 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17989 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17990 "use-server" rule).
17991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017992 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17993
17994 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17995 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17996
17997 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17998
17999 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18000 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18001 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18002
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018003 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18004 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018005 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018006 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18007 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18008
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018009 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18010
18011 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18012 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18013
18014 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18015
18016 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18017
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018018The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18019was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18021starvation, attacks, etc...
18022
18023The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18024alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18025easier finding and understanding.
18026
18027 Flags Reason
18028
18029 -- Normal termination.
18030
18031 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18032 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18033 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18034 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18035
18036 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18037 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18038 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18039 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18040 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18041 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018042
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018043 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18044 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018045 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018046
18047 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18048 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18049 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18050
18051 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18052 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18053 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18054 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18055 the server takes too long to respond.
18056
18057 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18058 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18059 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18060 long a time to respond.
18061
18062 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18063 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18064 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18065 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018066 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18067 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018068
18069 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18070 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18071 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18072 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18073 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018074 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018075 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18076 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18077 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18078 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18079 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18080 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18081 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18082 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018083 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018084 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18085 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18086 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087
18088 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18089 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018090 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18091 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18092 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18093 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018094
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018095 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18096 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018098 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018099 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18100 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018101 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18103 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18104
18105 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18106 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18107 503 or 504 here.
18108
18109 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18110 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18111 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18112 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18113 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18114
18115 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18116 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018117 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18119 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18120
18121 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18122 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18123 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18124 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18125 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18126 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18127 between haproxy and the server.
18128
18129 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18130 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18131 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18132 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18133 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18134 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18135 solution is to fix the application.
18136
18137 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18138 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18139 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18140 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18141 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18142 external attacks.
18143
18144 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18145 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018146 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018147 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18148 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18149
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018150 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18151 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18152 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018153 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018154 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018155
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018156 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18157 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18158 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18159 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018160 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18161 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18162 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18163 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18164 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018165
18166 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18167 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18168 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18169 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18170
18171 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18172 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18173 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18174 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18175
18176 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18177 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18178 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18179 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18180
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018181The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18182persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18183important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18184re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18185
18186 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18187
18188 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18189 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18190 set on a GET request.
18191
18192 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18193 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018194 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018195 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18196
18197 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18198 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18199 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18200
18201 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18202 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18203 already got a cookie.
18204
18205 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18206 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18207 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18208 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18209 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18210
18211 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18212 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18213 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18214
18215 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18216 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18217 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18218
18219 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18220 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18221
18222 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18223 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18224 then advertised in the response.
18225
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182278.6. Non-printable characters
18228-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018229
18230In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18231consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18232converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18233prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18234being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18235escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18236is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18237'}' when logging headers.
18238
18239Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18240issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18241containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18242
18243Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18244the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18245performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18246
18247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182488.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18249---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018250
18251Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18252achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018253section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018254cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18255the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18256the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018257locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018258not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18259user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18260a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18261wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18262
18263 Examples :
18264 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18265 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18266
18267 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18268 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18269
18270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182718.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18272---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018273
18274Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18275proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18276the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18277server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18278
18279Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18280response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018281section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018282
18283It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018284time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18285appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018286are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18287and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18288follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18289request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18290in the logs.
18291
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018292As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18293frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18294an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18295
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018296 Example :
18297 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18298 listen proxy-out
18299 mode http
18300 option httplog
18301 option logasap
18302 log global
18303 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18304
18305 # log the name of the virtual server
18306 capture request header Host len 20
18307
18308 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18309 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18310
18311 # log the beginning of the referrer
18312 capture request header Referer len 20
18313
18314 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18315 capture response header Server len 20
18316
18317 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18318 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18319
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018320 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018321 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18322
18323 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18324 capture response header Via len 20
18325
18326 # log the URL location during a redirection
18327 capture response header Location len 20
18328
18329 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18330 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18331 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18332 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18333 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18334
18335 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18336 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18337 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18338 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018339 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018340
18341 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18342 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18343 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18344 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18345 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018346 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018347
18348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183498.9. Examples of logs
18350---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018351
18352These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18353them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18354reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18355
18356 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18357 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18358 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18359
18360 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18361 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18362
18363 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18364 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18365 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18366
18367 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18368 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18369
18370 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18371 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18372 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18373
18374 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018375 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018376 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18377 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18378
18379 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18380 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18381 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18382
18383 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18384 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018385 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018386 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18387 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18388 to return the 502 and not the server.
18389
18390 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018391 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018392
18393 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18394 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18395 Nothing was sent to any server.
18396
18397 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18398 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18399
18400 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18401 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018402 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403 send a 408 return code to the client.
18404
18405 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18406 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18407
18408 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18409 5 seconds ("c----").
18410
18411 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18412 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018413 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018414
18415 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018416 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018417 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18418 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18419 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18420 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18421 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018422
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018423
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184249. Supported filters
18425--------------------
18426
18427Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18428accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18429unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18430
18431See also : "filter"
18432
184339.1. Trace
18434----------
18435
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018436filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018437
18438 Arguments:
18439 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18440 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18441
18442 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18443 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18444 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18445 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018447 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018448 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18449 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18450 amount of the parsed data.
18451
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018452 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018453
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018454This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18455callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18456information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18457filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18458
18459Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18460tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18461a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18462
18463
184649.2. HTTP compression
18465---------------------
18466
18467filter compression
18468
18469The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18470keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018471when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18472it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18473response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18474line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18475cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18476the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018477
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018478See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018479
18480
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200184819.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18482--------------------------------------------
18483
18484filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18485
18486 Arguments :
18487
18488 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18489 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18490 parsed.
18491
18492 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18493 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18494 part must be placed in its own scope.
18495
18496The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18497external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018498streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018499exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18500also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18501
18502SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18503the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18504
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018505For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018506"doc/SPOE.txt".
18507
18508Important note:
18509 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18510 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18511
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185129.4. Cache
18513----------
18514
18515filter cache <name>
18516
18517 Arguments :
18518
18519 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18520
18521The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18522"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018523cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018524other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18525the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18526mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18527filter other than the compression is used for the same
18528listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18529order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018530
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018531See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018532
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001853310. Cache
18534---------
18535
18536HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18537(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18538RAM.
18539
18540The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018541this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018542
18543If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18544independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18545when we try to allocate a new one.
18546
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018547The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018548
18549It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18550"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18551for more details.
18552
18553When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18554replaced by "<CACHE>".
18555
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001855610.1. Limitation
18557----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018558
18559The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18560
18561- If the response is not a 200
18562- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018563- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018564- If the response is not cacheable
18565
18566- If the request is not a GET
18567- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018568- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018569
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018570Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18571filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18572can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18573example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18574"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018575
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001857610.2. Setup
18577-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018578
18579To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18580the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18581
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001858210.2.1. Cache section
18583---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018584
18585cache <name>
18586 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18587 size of cache is mandatory.
18588
18589total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018590 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018591 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018592
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018593max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018594 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18595 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18596 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018597
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018598max-age <seconds>
18599 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18600 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18601 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18602 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18603 default.
18604
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001860510.2.2. Proxy section
18606---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018607
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018608http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018609 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18610 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18611 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18612 after this one.
18613
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018614http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018615 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18616 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18617 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18618 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18619
18620
18621Example:
18622
18623 backend bck1
18624 mode http
18625
18626 http-request cache-use foobar
18627 http-response cache-store foobar
18628 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18629
18630 cache foobar
18631 total-max-size 4
18632 max-age 240
18633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018634/*
18635 * Local variables:
18636 * fill-column: 79
18637 * End:
18638 */